blob: a505f70adaad1ade4e0190125b632e37f86527af [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue59fcdd2016-11-25 16:39:17 +01007 2016/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004702.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
539 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200540 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200542 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200544 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100546 - presetenv
547 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 - uid
549 - ulimit-n
550 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100551 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200552 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200553 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
554 - ssl-default-bind-options
555 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-server-options
557 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100558 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100559 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100560 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100561 - 51degrees-data-file
562 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200563 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200564 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100565 - wurfl-data-file
566 - wurfl-information-list
567 - wurfl-information-list-separator
568 - wurfl-engine-mode
569 - wurfl-cache-size
570 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200573 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200575 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100576 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100577 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100578 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200579 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200580 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200581 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200582 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583 - noepoll
584 - nokqueue
585 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100586 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300587 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000588 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200589 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200590 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200591 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - tune.buffers.limit
593 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200594 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200595 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100596 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100597 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200598 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100599 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100600 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100601 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.session-timeout
603 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200604 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100605 - tune.maxaccept
606 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200607 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200608 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200609 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100610 - tune.rcvbuf.client
611 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100612 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100613 - tune.sndbuf.client
614 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100615 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100616 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200617 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200619 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200620 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100621 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200622 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100623 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200624 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
625 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
626 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100627 - tune.zlib.memlevel
628 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630 * Debugging
631 - debug
632 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633
634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006353.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636------------------------------------
637
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200638ca-base <dir>
639 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200640 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
641 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643chroot <jail dir>
644 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
645 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
646 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
647 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
648 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
649 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100650
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100651cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
652 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
653 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
654 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100655 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
656 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
657 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
658 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
659 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
660 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
661 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
662 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
663 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
664 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100665
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200666crt-base <dir>
667 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
668 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
669 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671daemon
672 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
673 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
674 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
675
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200676deviceatlas-json-file <path>
677 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
678 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
679
680deviceatlas-log-level <value>
681 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
682 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
683
684deviceatlas-separator <char>
685 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
686 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
687
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100688deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200689 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
690 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
691 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100692
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900693external-check
694 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
695 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
696 See "option external-check".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698gid <number>
699 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
700 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100702 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
703 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706group <group name>
707 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
708 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200710log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
712 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100713 configured with "log global".
714
715 <address> can be one of:
716
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100717 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100718 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
719 port).
720
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100721 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
722 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
723 port).
724
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100725 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
726 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
727 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
728 writeable).
729
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
731 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100732
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200733 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
734 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
735 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
736 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
737 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
738 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
739 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
740 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
741 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
742 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
743 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
744
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200745 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
746 one of the following :
747
748 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
749 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
750
751 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
752 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
753
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100754 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
756 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
757 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
758 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
759
760 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200761 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
762 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
763 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
764 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
765 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
766 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200769
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100770log-send-hostname [<string>]
771 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
772 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
773 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
774 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
775 the logs.
776
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000777log-tag <string>
778 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
779 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
780 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100781 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000782
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100783lua-load <file>
784 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
785 used multiple times.
786
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787nbproc <number>
788 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
789 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
790 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
791 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
792 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
793
794pidfile <pidfile>
795 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
796 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
797 starting the process. See also "daemon".
798
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100799presetenv <name> <value>
800 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
801 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
802 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
803 and "unsetenv".
804
805resetenv [<name> ...]
806 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
807 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
808 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
809 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
810 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
811 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
812 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
813 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
814
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100815stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
817 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
818 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
819 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
820 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
821 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100822 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200823 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
824 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200825
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200826server-state-base <directory>
827 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200828 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
829 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200830
831server-state-file <file>
832 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
833 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
834 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
835 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
836 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
837 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
838 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
839 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200840 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
841 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200842
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100843setenv <name> <value>
844 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
845 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
846 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
847 and "unsetenv".
848
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100849ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300852 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100853 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
854 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
855 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
856 "bind" keyword for more information.
857
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100858ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
860 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
861 keyword to see available options.
862
863 Example:
864 global
865 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100867ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
869 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300870 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100871 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
872 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
873 information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880ssl-dh-param-file <file>
881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
882 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
883 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
884 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
885 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200886 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
887 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
888 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
889 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200890 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
891 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
892 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
893
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100894ssl-server-verify [none|required]
895 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
896 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
897 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
898
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200899stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
900 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
901 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
902 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200903 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
904 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200905
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200906 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
907 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
908 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200909
910stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
911 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
912 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100913 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200914
915stats maxconn <connections>
916 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
917 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919uid <number>
920 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
921 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
922 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
923 one. See also "gid" and "user".
924
925ulimit-n <number>
926 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
927 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
928 option.
929
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100930unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
931 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
932
933 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
934 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
935 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
936 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
937 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
938 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
939 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
940 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
941 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
942 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
943
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944unsetenv [<name> ...]
945 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
946 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
947 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
948 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
949 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
950 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
951 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
952
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953user <user name>
954 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
955 See also "uid" and "group".
956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200957node <name>
958 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
959
960 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
961 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
962 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
963 traffic.
964
965description <text>
966 Add a text that describes the instance.
967
968 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
969 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
970 "<" and ">" characters.
971
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010097251degrees-data-file <file path>
973 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
974 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
975
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200976 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100977 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
978
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000097951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100980 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
981 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
982 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
983
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200984 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100985 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
986
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100988 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
989 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
990
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200991 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
992 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
993
99451degrees-cache-size <number>
995 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
996 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
997 By default, this cache is disabled.
998
999 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001000 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1001
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001002wurfl-data-file <file path>
1003 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1004 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1005
1006 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1007 with USE_WURFL=1.
1008
1009wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1010 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1011 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1012 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1013
1014 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1015
1016 Valid WURFL properties are:
1017 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1018
1019 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1020 device.
1021
1022 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1023 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1024
1025 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1026 particular web request.
1027
1028 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1029 used Libwurfl API version.
1030
1031 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1032 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1033 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1034
1035 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1036 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1037
1038 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1039 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1040
1041 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1042
1043 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1044
1045 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1046 with USE_WURFL=1.
1047
1048wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1049 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1050 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1051
1052 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1053 with USE_WURFL=1.
1054
1055wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1056 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1057 thus before the chroot.
1058
1059 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1060 with USE_WURFL=1.
1061
1062wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1063 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1064 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1065 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1066 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1067 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1068 mode is enabled by default.
1069
1070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1071 with USE_WURFL=1.
1072
1073wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1074 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1075 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1076 - "0" : no cache is used.
1077 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1078 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1079 the highest performing option.
1080
1081 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1082 with USE_WURFL=1.
1083
1084wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1085 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1086 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1087
1088 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1089 with USE_WURFL=1.
1090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093-----------------------
1094
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001095max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1096 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1097 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1098 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1099 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1100 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1101 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1102 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1103 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1104
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105maxconn <number>
1106 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1107 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1108 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001109 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1110 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1111 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1112 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001113 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1114 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1115 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1116 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1117 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001119maxconnrate <number>
1120 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1121 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1122 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1123 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1124 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1125 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1126 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1127 fairness.
1128
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001129maxcomprate <number>
1130 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001131 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001132 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1133 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1134 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1135 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1136 default value.
1137
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001138maxcompcpuusage <number>
1139 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1140 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1141 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1142 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1143 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1144 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1145 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1146 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1147
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001148maxpipes <number>
1149 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1150 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1151 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1152 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1153 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1154 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1155
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001156maxsessrate <number>
1157 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1158 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1159 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1160 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1161 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1162 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1163 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1164 fairness.
1165
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001166maxsslconn <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1168 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1169 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1170 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1171 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1172 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1173 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001174 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1175 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1176 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1177 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1178 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1179 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1180 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001181
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001182maxsslrate <number>
1183 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1184 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1185 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1186 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1187 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1188 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1189 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1190 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1191 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1192 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1193
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001194maxzlibmem <number>
1195 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1196 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1197 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001198 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1199 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1200 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1201
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001202noepoll
1203 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1204 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001205 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
1207nokqueue
1208 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1209 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1210 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1211
1212nopoll
1213 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1214 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001216 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001218nosplice
1219 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1220 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1221 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001223 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1224 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1225 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1226 "option splice-response".
1227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001228nogetaddrinfo
1229 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1230 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1231
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001232noreuseport
1233 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1234 command line argument "-dR".
1235
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001236spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001237 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1238 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1239 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1240 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1241 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1242 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001243
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001244tune.buffers.limit <number>
1245 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1246 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1247 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1248 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1249 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1250 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1251 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1252 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1253 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1254 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1255 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1256 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1257 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1258 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1259 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1260
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001261tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1262 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1263 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1264 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1265 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1266
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001267tune.bufsize <number>
1268 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1269 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1270 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1271 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1272 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1273 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1274 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1275 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001276 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1277 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1278 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001280tune.chksize <number>
1281 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1282 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1283 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1284 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1285 checks whenever possible.
1286
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001287tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1288 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1289 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1290 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1291 this value. The default value is 1.
1292
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001293tune.http.cookielen <number>
1294 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1295 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1296 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1297 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1298 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1299 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1300 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1301 to change this value.
1302
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001303tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1304 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1305 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1306 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1307 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1308 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1309 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1310 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1311 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1312 limit too high.
1313
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001314tune.idletimer <timeout>
1315 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1316 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1317 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1318 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1319 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1320 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1321 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1322 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1323 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1324
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001325tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1326 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001327 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001328 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1329 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1330 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1331 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1332 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1333
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001334tune.lua.maxmem
1335 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1336 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1337 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1338 memory.
1339
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001340tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1341 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001342 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1343 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1344 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345
1346tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1347 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1348 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1349 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1350 check servers.
1351
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001352tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1353 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1354 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1355 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1356 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1357
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001358tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001359 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1360 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1361 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1362 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1363 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1364 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1365 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1366 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1367 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1368 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001369
1370tune.maxpollevents <number>
1371 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1372 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1373 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1374 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1375 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1376
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001377tune.maxrewrite <number>
1378 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1379 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1380 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1381 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1382 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1383 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1384 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1385 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1386 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1387 bufsize.
1388
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001389tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1390 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1391 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1392 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1393 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1394 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1395 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1396 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1397 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1398 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1399 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1400 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1401 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1402 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1403 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1404 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1405 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1406 setting this parameter to 0.
1407
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001408tune.pipesize <number>
1409 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1410 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1411 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1412 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1413 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1414 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1415
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001416tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1417tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1418 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1419 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1420 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1421 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1422 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1423 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1424 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1425
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001426tune.recv_enough <number>
1427 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1428 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1429 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1430 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1431 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1434tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1436 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1443 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1444 notifying haproxy again.
1445
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001446tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001447 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1448 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1449 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001451 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1452 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1453 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1454 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1455 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001456 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1457 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001458
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001459tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1460 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1461 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1462 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1463 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1464 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1465 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1466
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001467tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1468 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001469 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001470 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1471 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1472 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1473 being used for too long.
1474
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001475tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1476 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1477 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1478 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1479 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1480 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1481 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1482 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1483 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1484 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1485 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001486 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1487 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001488
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001489tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1490 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1491 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1492 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1493 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1494 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1495 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1496 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001497 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1498 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001499
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001500tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1501 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1502 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1503 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1504 1000 entries.
1505
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001506tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1508 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1509 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1510
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001511tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001512tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001513tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1514tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1515tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001516 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1517 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1518 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1519 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1520 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1521 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1522 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1523 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001524
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001525 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1526 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1527 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1528 all available space is consumed.
1529 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1530 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1531 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001532
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001533tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1534 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001535 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001536 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1537 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1538 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1539
1540tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1541 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1542 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1543 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1544 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015463.3. Debugging
1547--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
1549debug
1550 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1551 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1552 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1553 system startup.
1554
1555quiet
1556 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1557 line argument "-q".
1558
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015603.4. Userlists
1561--------------
1562It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1563http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1564it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1565
1566userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001567 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001568 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1569
1570group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001571 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001572 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1573 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1574
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001575user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1576 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001577 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1578 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001579 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1580 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001581 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001582 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001583
1584
1585 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001586 userlist L1
1587 group G1 users tiger,scott
1588 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001590 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1591 user scott insecure-password elgato
1592 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001593
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001594 userlist L2
1595 group G1
1596 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001597
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001598 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1599 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1600 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001601
1602 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001604
16053.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001606----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001607It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1608several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1609instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1610values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1611automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1612In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1613using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1614tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1615reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1616Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1617that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1618each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001619
1620peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001621 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001622 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1623
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001624disabled
1625 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1626 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1627 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1628
1629enable
1630 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1631
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001632peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1633 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1634 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1635 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1636 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1637 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1638 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1639
1640 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1641 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1642
1643 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1644 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1645 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1646 across all peers.
1647
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001648 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1649 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001650
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001651 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001652 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001653 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1654 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1655 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656
1657 backend mybackend
1658 mode tcp
1659 balance roundrobin
1660 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1661 stick on src
1662
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001663 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1664 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001665
1666
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016673.6. Mailers
1668------------
1669It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1670If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1671in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1672
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001673mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001674 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1675 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1676
1677mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1678 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1679
1680 Example:
1681 mailers mymailers
1682 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1683 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1684
1685 backend mybackend
1686 mode tcp
1687 balance roundrobin
1688
1689 email-alert mailers mymailers
1690 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1691 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1692
1693 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1694 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1695
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001696timeout mail <time>
1697 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1698 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1699 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1700 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1701
1702 Example:
1703 mailers mymailers
1704 timeout mail 20s
1705 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017074. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001708----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001710Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001711 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712 - frontend <name>
1713 - backend <name>
1714 - listen <name>
1715
1716A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1717its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1718section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001720
1721A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1722connections.
1723
1724A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1725to forward incoming connections.
1726
1727A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1728parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001730All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1731'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1732case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1733
1734Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1735logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1736proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1737However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1738name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1739
1740Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1741and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1744modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1745arbitrary criteria.
1746
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001747In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1748a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1749the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1750
1751 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1752 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1753 between responses and new requests.
1754
1755 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1756 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1757 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1758 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1759
1760 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1761 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1762 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1763
1764 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1765 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1766 client-facing connection remains open.
1767
1768 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1769 after the end of the response.
1770
1771The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1772frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1773following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1774weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1775
1776 Backend mode
1777
1778 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1779 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1780 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1781 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1782 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1783 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1784 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1785 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1786 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1787 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1788 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017924.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1793--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001795The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1796limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1797they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1798limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001799marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001800option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001801and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1802with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1803specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001805
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001806 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1807------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1808acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001809appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001810backlog X X X -
1811balance X - X X
1812bind - X X -
1813bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001814block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001815capture cookie - X X -
1816capture request header - X X -
1817capture response header - X X -
1818clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001819compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001820contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1821cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001822declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823default-server X - X X
1824default_backend X X X -
1825description - X X X
1826disabled X X X X
1827dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001828email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001829email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001830email-alert mailers X X X X
1831email-alert myhostname X X X X
1832email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001833enabled X X X X
1834errorfile X X X X
1835errorloc X X X X
1836errorloc302 X X X X
1837-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1838errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001839force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001840filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001841fullconn X - X X
1842grace X X X X
1843hash-type X - X X
1844http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001845http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001846http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001848http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001849http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001850http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001851id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001852ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001853load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001854log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001855log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001856log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001857log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001858max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001859maxconn X X X -
1860mode X X X X
1861monitor fail - X X -
1862monitor-net X X X -
1863monitor-uri X X X -
1864option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1865option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1866option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1867option allbackups (*) X - X X
1868option checkcache (*) X - X X
1869option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1870option contstats (*) X X X -
1871option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1872option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1873option forceclose (*) X X X X
1874-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1875option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001876option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001877option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001878option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001879option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001880option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001882option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1884option httpchk X - X X
1885option httpclose (*) X X X X
1886option httplog X X X X
1887option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001888option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001889option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001890option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1892option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1893option logasap (*) X X X -
1894option mysql-check X - X X
1895option nolinger (*) X X X X
1896option originalto X X X X
1897option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001898option pgsql-check X - X X
1899option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001901option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option smtpchk X - X X
1903option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1904option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1905option splice-request (*) X X X X
1906option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001907option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1909option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1910-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001911option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1913option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1914option tcpka X X X X
1915option tcplog X X X X
1916option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001917external-check command X - X X
1918external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1920rate-limit sessions X X X -
1921redirect - X X X
1922redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1923redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1924reqadd - X X X
1925reqallow - X X X
1926reqdel - X X X
1927reqdeny - X X X
1928reqiallow - X X X
1929reqidel - X X X
1930reqideny - X X X
1931reqipass - X X X
1932reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001933reqitarpit - X X X
1934reqpass - X X X
1935reqrep - X X X
1936-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001937reqtarpit - X X X
1938retries X - X X
1939rspadd - X X X
1940rspdel - X X X
1941rspdeny - X X X
1942rspidel - X X X
1943rspideny - X X X
1944rspirep - X X X
1945rsprep - X X X
1946server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001947server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001948source X - X X
1949srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001950stats admin - X X X
1951stats auth X X X X
1952stats enable X X X X
1953stats hide-version X X X X
1954stats http-request - X X X
1955stats realm X X X X
1956stats refresh X X X X
1957stats scope X X X X
1958stats show-desc X X X X
1959stats show-legends X X X X
1960stats show-node X X X X
1961stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001962-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1963stick match - - X X
1964stick on - - X X
1965stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001966stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001967stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001968tcp-check connect - - X X
1969tcp-check expect - - X X
1970tcp-check send - - X X
1971tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001972tcp-request connection - X X -
1973tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001974tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001975tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001976tcp-response content - - X X
1977tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001978timeout check X - X X
1979timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001980timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001981timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1982timeout connect X - X X
1983timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1984timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1985timeout http-request X X X X
1986timeout queue X - X X
1987timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001988timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001989timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1990timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001991timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001992transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001993unique-id-format X X X -
1994unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001996use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001997------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1998 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020014.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2002---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
2004This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2005
2006
2007acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2008 Declare or complete an access list.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 no | yes | yes | yes
2011 Example:
2012 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2013 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2014 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002016 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002019appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2020 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2023 no | no | yes | yes
2024 Arguments :
2025 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2026 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2027
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002028 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029 checked in each cookie value.
2030
2031 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2032 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2033 milliseconds.
2034
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002035 request-learn
2036 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2037 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2038 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2039 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2040 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2041 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002043 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2044 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2045 data following this prefix.
2046
2047 Example :
2048 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2049
2050 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2051 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2052
2053 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2054 2 modes are currently supported :
2055 - path-parameters :
2056 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2057 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2058 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2059 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2060 - query-string :
2061 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2062 query string.
2063
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002064 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2065 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2066 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002068 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2069 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
2071
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002072backlog <conns>
2073 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2075 yes | yes | yes | no
2076 Arguments :
2077 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2078 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002079 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002080
2081 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2082 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2083 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2084 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2085 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2086 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2087 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2088 backlog parameter.
2089
2090 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2091 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2092 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2093
2094 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2095
2096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002098balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 yes | no | yes | yes
2102 Arguments :
2103 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2104 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2105 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2106 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2107
2108 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2109 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2110 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2111 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002112 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002113 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002114 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2115 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2116 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2117 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2118 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2119 it, so that you don't worry.
2120
2121 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2122 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2123 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2124 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2125 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2126 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2127 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2128 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002130 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2131 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2132 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2133 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2134 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2135 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2136 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2137 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2138
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002139 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002140 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002141 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2142 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002143 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002144 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2145 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2146 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2147 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2148 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002149 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2150 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2151 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2152 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2153 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2154 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2157 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2158 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2159 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2160 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2161 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2162 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2163 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002164 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002166 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2167 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2168 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002170 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2171 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2172 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2173 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2174 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2175 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2176 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2177 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2178 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2179 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2180 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2181 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002183 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002184 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2185 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2186 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2187 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2188 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2189 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2190 URIs start with a leading "/".
2191
2192 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2193 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2194 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2195 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2196
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002198 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2199
2200 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002201 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2202 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002203 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2204 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2205 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2206 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002207 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002208 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2209 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002210
2211 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2212 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2213 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2214 server will receive the request.
2215
2216 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2217 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2218 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2219 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2220 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002221 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2222 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2223 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002225 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2226 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2227 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2228 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2229 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002231 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002232 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2233 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2234 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2235
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002236 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2237 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2238 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2239
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002240 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002241 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002242 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2243 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2244 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2245 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2246 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2247 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002249 used instead.
2250
2251 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2252 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2253 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2254 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2255
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002256 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2257 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2258 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2259
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002260 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002263 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2264 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002265
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002266 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2267 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2268 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269
2270 Examples :
2271 balance roundrobin
2272 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002273 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002274 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2275 balance hdr(host)
2276 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002277
2278 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2279 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002281 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2283 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2284 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2285 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2286
2287 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2288 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2289 defaults to 16 kB.
2290
2291 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2292 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2293
2294 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2295 Round Robin.
2296
2297 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2298 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2299 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2300 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2301
2302 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2303
2304 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002305 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002306 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2307 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2308 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002310 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311
2312
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002313bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2314bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2317 no | yes | yes | no
2318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002319 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2320 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2321 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2322 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002323 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002324 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2325 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2326 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2327 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2328 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2329 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2330 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002331 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2332 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2333 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2334 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2335 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2336 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2337 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002338 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2339 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2340 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002341 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2342 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2343 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002344
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002345 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2346 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002347 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2348 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2349 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002350 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2351 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2352 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2353 the range.
2354
2355 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2356 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2357 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2358 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2359 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2360 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2361 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002362 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002363 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002365 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2366 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2367 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2368 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2369 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2370 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2371 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2372 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2373
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002374 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2375 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2376 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2377 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2380 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2381 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2382 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2383 in a frontend.
2384
2385 Example :
2386 listen http_proxy
2387 bind :80,:443
2388 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002389 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002391 listen http_https_proxy
2392 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002393 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002394
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002395 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2396 bind ipv6@:80
2397 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2398 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2399
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002400 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002401 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002402
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002403 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2404 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2405 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2406 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2407 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2408
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002409 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002410 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411
2412
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002413bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002414 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 yes | yes | yes | yes
2417 Arguments :
2418 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2419 may be used to override a default value.
2420
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002421 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002422 option may be combined with other numbers.
2423
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002424 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002425 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2426 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2427 missing from all processes.
2428
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002429 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002430 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002431 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2432 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2433 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2434 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002435
2436 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2437 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2438 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2439 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2440 and 'even' instances.
2441
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002442 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2443 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2444 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2445 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002446
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002447 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2448 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2449
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002450 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2451 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2452 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2453
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002454 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2455 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2456
2457 Example :
2458 listen app_ip1
2459 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002460 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002461
2462 listen app_ip2
2463 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002464 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002465
2466 listen management
2467 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002468 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002469
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002470 listen management
2471 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2472 bind-process 1-4
2473
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002474 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002475
2476
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002477block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 no | yes | yes | yes
2481
2482 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2483 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002484 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002485 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2487 "block" statements per instance.
2488
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002489 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2490 "http-request deny" instead.
2491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 Example:
2493 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2494 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2495 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2496 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002498 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
2500
2501capture cookie <name> len <length>
2502 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 no | yes | yes | no
2505 Arguments :
2506 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2507 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2508 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2509 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2510 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2511
2512 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2513 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2514 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2515 right if it exceeds <length>.
2516
2517 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2518 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2519 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2520 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2521
2522 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2523 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2524 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2525
2526 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2527 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2528 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002529 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2530 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2531 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532
2533 Example:
2534 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2535
2536 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002537 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538
2539
2540capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002541 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 no | yes | yes | no
2544 Arguments :
2545 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002546 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2548 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2549 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2550
2551 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2552 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2553 it exceeds <length>.
2554
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002555 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2557 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002558 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2559 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2560 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2561 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002562 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002563 environments to find where the request came from.
2564
2565 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2566 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2567 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2568 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002570 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2571 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2572 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2573 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2574 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
2576 Example:
2577 capture request header Host len 15
2578 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002579 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002581 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002582 about logging.
2583
2584
2585capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002586 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2588 no | yes | yes | no
2589 Arguments :
2590 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002591 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2593 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2594 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2595
2596 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2597 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2598 it exceeds <length>.
2599
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002600 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2602 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2603 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002604 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2605 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2606 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2607 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002609 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2610 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2611 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2612 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2613 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614
2615 Example:
2616 capture response header Content-length len 9
2617 capture response header Location len 15
2618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002619 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 about logging.
2621
2622
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002624 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 yes | yes | yes | no
2627 Arguments :
2628 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2630 as explained at the top of this document.
2631
2632 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2633 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2634 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2635 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2636 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2637 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2638 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2639 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002640 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2642 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2643
2644 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2645 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2646 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2647 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2648 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2649 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2650
2651 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2652 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2653
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002654 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2655 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002656
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002657compression algo <algorithm> ...
2658compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002659compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002660 Enable HTTP compression.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | yes | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002664 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2665 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2666 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2667
2668 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002669 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2670 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2671 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002672
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002673 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002674 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002675
2676 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2677 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2678 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2679 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2680 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002681 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002682
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002683 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2684 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2685 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2686 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2687 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2688 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2689 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002690 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002691
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002692 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002693 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002694 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2695 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2696 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2697 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2698 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002699
2700 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2701 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2702 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2703 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2704 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002705 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2706 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2707 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2708 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2709 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002710 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2711 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002712
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002713 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002714 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2715 "Accept-Encoding" header
2716 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002717 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002718 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2719 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002720 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2721 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2722 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2723 "multipart"
2724 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2725 header
2726 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2727 and later
2728 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2729 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002730
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002731 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2732 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002733
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002734 Examples :
2735 compression algo gzip
2736 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002738
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002739contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2742 yes | no | yes | yes
2743 Arguments :
2744 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2745 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2746 as explained at the top of this document.
2747
2748 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002749 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002750 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2752 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2753 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2754 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2755
2756 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2757 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2758 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2759 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2760 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2761 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2762
2763 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2764 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2765 instead.
2766
2767 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2768 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2769
2770
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002771cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002772 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2773 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2776 yes | no | yes | yes
2777 Arguments :
2778 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2779 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2780 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2781 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2782 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2783 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2784 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2785 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2786 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2787
2788 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2789 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2790 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2791 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2792 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2793 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002794 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2795 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2796 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2797 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2798 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002801 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002802
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002803 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002804 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2805 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2806 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2807 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2808 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2809 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2810 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2811 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2812 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2813 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002814
2815 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2816 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2817 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2818 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2819 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2820 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2821 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2822 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2823 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002824 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002825 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2826 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2827 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002829 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2830 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2831 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002832 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2833 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2834 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2835 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002836 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2837 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2838 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
2840 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2841 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2842 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2843 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2844 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2845 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2846 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2847 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2848 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2849
2850 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2851 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2852 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2853 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2854 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2855 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2856 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2857 persistence cookie in the cache.
2858 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2859
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002860 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2861 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2862 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2863 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2864 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2865 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2866 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2867 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2868 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2869 they logout.
2870
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002871 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2872 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2873 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2874 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2875
2876 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2877 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2878 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2879 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2880 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2881 this attribute.
2882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002883 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002884 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002885 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2886 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2887 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2888 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2889 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2890 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002891
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002892 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2893 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2894 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2895 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2896 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2897 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2898 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2899 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2900 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2901 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2902 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2903 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2904 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2905 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2906 the site.
2907
2908 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2909 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2910 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2911 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2912 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2913 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2914 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2915 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2916 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2917 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2918 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2919 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2920 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2921 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2922 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2923 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2926 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2927 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2928 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930 Examples :
2931 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2932 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2933 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002934 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002936 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002937
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002938
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002939declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2940 Declares a capture slot.
2941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2942 no | yes | yes | no
2943 Arguments:
2944 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2945
2946 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2947 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2948 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2949 for use in the response.
2950
2951 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002952 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002953 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2954
2955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002956default-server [param*]
2957 Change default options for a server in a backend
2958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2959 yes | no | yes | yes
2960 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002961 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2962 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2963 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2964 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002965
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002966 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002967 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2968
2969 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002972default_backend <backend>
2973 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2975 yes | yes | yes | no
2976 Arguments :
2977 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2978
2979 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2980 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2981 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2982 will catch all undetermined requests.
2983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984 Example :
2985
2986 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2987 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2988 default_backend dynamic
2989
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002990 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002993description <string>
2994 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 no | yes | yes | yes
2997 Arguments : string
2998
2999 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3000 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3001 it describes.
3002 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3003
3004
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003005disabled
3006 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3008 yes | yes | yes | yes
3009 Arguments : none
3010
3011 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3012 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3013 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3014 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3015 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3016 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3017 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3018
3019 See also : "enabled"
3020
3021
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003022dispatch <address>:<port>
3023 Set a default server address
3024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3025 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003026 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003027
3028 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3029 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3030 during start-up.
3031
3032 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3033 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3034 possible with normal servers.
3035
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003036 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003037 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3038 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3039 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3040 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3041
3042 See also : "server"
3043
3044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045enabled
3046 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3048 yes | yes | yes | yes
3049 Arguments : none
3050
3051 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3052 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3053
3054 See also : "disabled"
3055
3056
3057errorfile <code> <file>
3058 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3060 yes | yes | yes | yes
3061 Arguments :
3062 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003063 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3064 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065
3066 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003067 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003069 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3070 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071
3072 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3073 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3074 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3075
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003076 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3079 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3080 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3081 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3082
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003083 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3084 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3085 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3086 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3087 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3088 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3091 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3092 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003093 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3095
3096 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3097
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003098 Example :
3099 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003100 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003101 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3102 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003104
3105errorloc <code> <url>
3106errorloc302 <code> <url>
3107 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3109 yes | yes | yes | yes
3110 Arguments :
3111 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003112 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003113
3114 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3115 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3116 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3117 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3118 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3119
3120 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3121 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3122 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3123
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003124 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003126 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3127 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3128 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3129 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003130 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003131 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3132 request.
3133
3134 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3135
3136
3137errorloc303 <code> <url>
3138 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | yes
3141 Arguments :
3142 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3143 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3144
3145 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3146 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3147 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3148 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3149 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3150
3151 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3152 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3153 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3154
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003155 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3156
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003157 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3158 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3159 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3160 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003161 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003162
3163 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3164
3165
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003166email-alert from <emailaddr>
3167 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3168 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 yes | yes | yes | yes
3171
3172 Arguments :
3173
3174 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3175
3176 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3177 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3178
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003179 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003180 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3181 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003182
3183
3184email-alert level <level>
3185 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3186 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | yes | yes | yes
3189
3190 Arguments :
3191
3192 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3193 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3194 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3195
3196 By default level is alert
3197
3198 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3199 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3200 for the proxy.
3201
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003202 Alerts are sent when :
3203
3204 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3205 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3206 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3207 is notice or lower
3208 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3209 and a health check status update occurs
3210
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003211 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3212 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003213 section 3.6 about mailers.
3214
3215
3216email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3217 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | yes | yes | yes
3220
3221 Arguments :
3222
3223 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3224
3225 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3226 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3227
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003228 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3229 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003230
3231
3232email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3233 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3234 mailers.
3235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | yes | yes | yes
3237
3238 Arguments :
3239
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003240 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003241
3242 By default the systems hostname is used.
3243
3244 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3245 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3246 for the proxy.
3247
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003248 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3249 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003250
3251
3252email-alert to <emailaddr>
3253 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3254 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3256 yes | yes | yes | yes
3257
3258 Arguments :
3259
3260 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3261
3262 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3263 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3264
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003265 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003266 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3267
3268
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003269force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3270 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3272 no | yes | yes | yes
3273
3274 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3275 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3276 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3277 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3278 marked down for maintenance operations.
3279
3280 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3281 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3282 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3283 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3284 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3285 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3286 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3287 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3288 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3289
3290 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3291 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3292 is used.
3293
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003294 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003295 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003296
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003297
3298filter <name> [param*]
3299 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | yes
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3304 referenced in section 9.
3305
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003306 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003307 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003308 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3309 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003310
3311 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3312 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3313
3314 Example:
3315 listen
3316 bind *:80
3317
3318 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3319 filter compression
3320 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3321
3322 compression algo gzip
3323 compression offload
3324
3325 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3326
3327 See also : section 9.
3328
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003329
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003330fullconn <conns>
3331 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3333 yes | no | yes | yes
3334 Arguments :
3335 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3336 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3337
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003338 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003339 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003340 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3342 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3343 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3344 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3345 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003346 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003347
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003348 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3349 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003350 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3351 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3352 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003353
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003354 Example :
3355 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3356 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3357 # connections.
3358 backend dynamic
3359 fullconn 10000
3360 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3361 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3362
3363 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3364
3365
3366grace <time>
3367 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003370 Arguments :
3371 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3372 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3373 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3374
3375 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3376 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003377 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003378 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3379
3380 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3381 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3382 simplify it.
3383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003385hash-balance-factor <factor>
3386 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3388 yes | no | no | yes
3389 Arguments :
3390 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3391 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3392 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3393
3394 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3395 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3396 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3397 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3398 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3399 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3400 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3401
3402 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3403 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3404 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3405 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3406 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3407
3408 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3409
3410
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003411hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003412 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | no | yes | yes
3415 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003416 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3417 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003418
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003419 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3420 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3421 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3422 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3423 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3424 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3425 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3426 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3427 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3428 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003429
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003430 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3431 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3432 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3433 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3434 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3435 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3436 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3437 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3438 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3439 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3440 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3441 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3442 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003443 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3444 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003445
3446 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3447
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003448 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003449 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3450 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3451 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003452 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3453 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3454 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003455
3456 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3457 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003458 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3459 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3460 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3461 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3462
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003463 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3464 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3465 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3466 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3467 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3468 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3469 parameter.
3470
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003471 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3472 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3473 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3474 used on strings.
3475
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003476 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3477
3478 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3479 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3480 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3481 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3482 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3483 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3484 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3485 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3486 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3487 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3488 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3489 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003490
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003491 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3492 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3493 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003494
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003495 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003496
3497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498http-check disable-on-404
3499 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 Arguments : none
3503
3504 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3505 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3506 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3507 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3508 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3509 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3510 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3511 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003512 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3513 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3514 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3515
3516 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3517
3518
3519http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003520 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003522 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003523 Arguments :
3524 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3525 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003526 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003527 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3528 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3529 details on the supported keywords.
3530
3531 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3532 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3533 with the usual backslash ('\').
3534
3535 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3536 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3537 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3538 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3539 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3540
3541 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003543 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3544 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3545 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3546
3547 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003548 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003549 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3550 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3551 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3552 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3553
3554 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003555 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003556 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3557 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3558 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3559 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3560 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3561 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3562 trace).
3563
3564 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003565 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003566 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3567 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3568 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3569 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3570 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3571 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3572
3573 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3574 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3575 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3576 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3577 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3578 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3579 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3580 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3581
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003582 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3583 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3584 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3585
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003586 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3587 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3588
3589 Examples :
3590 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003591 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003592
3593 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003594 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003595
3596 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003597 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003598
3599 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003600 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003601
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003602 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003603
3604
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003605http-check send-state
3606 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | no | yes | yes
3609 Arguments : none
3610
3611 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3612 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3613 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3614 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3615 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3616
3617 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3618 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3619 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3620 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3621 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003622 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3623 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3624 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3625
3626 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3627 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3628 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3629
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003630 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3631 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3632 checked in multiple backends.
3633
3634 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3635 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3636
3637 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3638 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3639 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3640 one fails.
3641
3642 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3643 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3644 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3645
3646 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3647 server's queue.
3648
3649 Example of a header received by the application server :
3650 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3651 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3652
3653 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3654
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003655http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3656 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003657 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003658 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003659 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003660 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3661 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003662 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3663 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003664 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3665 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3666 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003667 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003668 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003669 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003670 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003671 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003672 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003673 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003674 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003675 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003676 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3677
3678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 no | yes | yes | yes
3680
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003681 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3682 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3683 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3684 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3685 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003686
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003687 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3688 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3689 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3690
3691 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003692 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3693 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3694 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3695 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003696
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003697 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3698 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3699 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003700 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3701 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003702 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3703 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3704 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3705 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3706 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003707 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003708 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3709 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003710
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003711 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3712 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3713 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3714 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3715 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3716
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003717 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3718 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3719 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003720 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3721 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003722
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003723 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3724 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3725 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3726 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3727 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3728 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3729 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3730 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3731
3732 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3733 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3734 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003735 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3736 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003737
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003738 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3739 <name>.
3740
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003741 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3742 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3743 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3744 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3745 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3746 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3747 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3748 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3749
3750 Example:
3751
3752 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3753
3754 applied to:
3755
3756 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3757
3758 outputs:
3759
3760 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3761
3762 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3763
3764 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3765 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3766 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3767 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3768 header.
3769
3770 Example:
3771
3772 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3773
3774 applied to:
3775
3776 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3777
3778 outputs:
3779
3780 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3781
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003782 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3783 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3784 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3785 it.
3786
3787 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3788 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3789 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3790 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3791 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3792 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3793
3794 Example :
3795 # prepend the host name before the path
3796 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3797
3798 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3799 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3800 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3801 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3802 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3803 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3804 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3805 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3806
3807 Example :
3808 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3809 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3810
3811 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3812 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3813 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3814 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3815 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3816 "set-query".
3817
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003818 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3819 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3820 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3821 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3822 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3823 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3824 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3825 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3826
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003827 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3828 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3829 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3830 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3831 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3832 another equipment.
3833
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003834 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3835 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3836 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3837 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3838 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3839 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3840 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3841 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3842
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003843 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3844 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3845 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3846 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3847 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3848 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3849 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3850 admin privileges.
3851
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003852 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3853 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3854 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3855 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3856 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3857 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3858 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3859 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3860
3861 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3862 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3863 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3864 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3865 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3866 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3867
3868 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3869 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3870 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3871 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3872 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3873 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3874
3875 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3876 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3877 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3878 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3879 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3880 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3881 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3882 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3883 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3884
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003885 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003886 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3887 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3888 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3889 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3890 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3891 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3892 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3893 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3894 request header" for more information.
3895
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003896 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3897 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3898 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3899 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003900 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3901 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003902
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003903 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3904 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3905 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3906 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3907 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3908 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3909 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3910 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3911 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3912 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3913 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3914 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3915
3916 These actions take one or two arguments :
3917 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3918 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3919 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3920 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3921
3922 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3923 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3924 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3925 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3926
3927 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3928 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3929 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3930 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3931 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3932 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3933 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3934 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3935
3936 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3937 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3938 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3939 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3940 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3941
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003942 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3943 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3944 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3945 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3946 continues.
3947
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003948 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3949 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3950 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3951 the actions evaluation continues.
3952
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003953 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3954 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3955 inline.
3956
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003957 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3958 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003959 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003960 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3961 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003962 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003963 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003964 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3966 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003967 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003968 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003969 and '_'.
3970
3971 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3972 followed by some converters.
3973
3974 Example:
3975
3976 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3977
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003978 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
3979 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
3980
3981 Example:
3982
3983 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
3984
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003985 - set-src <expr> :
3986 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3987 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3988 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3989 source IP for privacy.
3990
3991 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3992 followed by some converters.
3993
3994 Example:
3995
3996 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3997 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3998
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003999 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4000 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004001
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004002 - set-src-port <expr> :
4003 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4004 expression.
4005
4006 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4007 followed by some converters.
4008
4009 Example:
4010
4011 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4012 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4013
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004014 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4015 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4016 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004017
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004018 - set-dst <expr> :
4019 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4020 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4021 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4022 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4023 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4024
4025 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4026 followed by some converters.
4027
4028 Example:
4029
4030 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4031 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4032
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004033 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4034 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4035
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004036 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4037 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4038 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4039 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4040
4041 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4042 followed by some converters.
4043
4044 Example:
4045
4046 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4047 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4048
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004049 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4050 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4051 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4052
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004053 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4054 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4055 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4056 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4057 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4058 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4059 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4060 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4061 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4062 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4063 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4064 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4065 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4066 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4067 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4068 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4069
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004070 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4071
4072 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4073 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004074 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4075 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4076
4077 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4078 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4079 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4080 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004081
4082 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004083 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4084 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4085 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004086
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004087 http-request allow if nagios
4088 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4089 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4090 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004091
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004092 Example:
4093 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004094 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004095
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004096 Example:
4097 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4098 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004099 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004100 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4101 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4102 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4103 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4104 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4105 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4106
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004107 Example:
4108 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4109 acl add path /addacl
4110 acl del path /delacl
4111
4112 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4113
4114 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4115 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4116
4117 Example:
4118 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4119 acl setmap path /setmap
4120 acl delmap path /delmap
4121
4122 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4123
4124 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4125 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4126
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004127 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4128 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004129
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004130http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004131 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004132 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004133 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4134 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004135 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004136 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4137 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4138 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4139 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004140 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004141 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004142 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004143 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004144 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004145 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004146 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004147 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004149 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4150
4151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 no | yes | yes | yes
4153
4154 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4155 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4156 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4157 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4158 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4159 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4160
4161 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4162 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4163 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4164 current section.
4165
4166 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4167 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4168 rules are evaluated.
4169
4170 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4171 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4172 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4173 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4174 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4175 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4176 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4177
4178 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4179 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4180 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4181 external users.
4182
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004183 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4184 <name>.
4185
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004186 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4187 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4188 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4189 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4190 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4191 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4192 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4193 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4194
4195 Example:
4196
4197 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4198
4199 applied to:
4200
4201 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4202
4203 outputs:
4204
4205 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4206
4207 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4208
4209 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4210 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4211 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4212 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4213 header.
4214
4215 Example:
4216
4217 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4218
4219 applied to:
4220
4221 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4222
4223 outputs:
4224
4225 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4226
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004227 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004228 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4229 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4230 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004231
4232 Example:
4233
4234 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4235 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004236 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4237 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004238
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004239 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4240 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4241 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4242 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4243 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4244 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4245 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4246 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4247
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004248 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4249 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4250 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4251 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4252 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4253 another equipment.
4254
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004255 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4256 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4257 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4258 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4259 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4260 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4261 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4262 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4263
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004264 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4265 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4266 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4267 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4268 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4269 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4270 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4271 admin privileges.
4272
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004273 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4274 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4275 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4276 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4277 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4278 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4279 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4280 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4281
4282 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4283 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4284 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4285 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4286 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4287 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4288
4289 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4290 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4291 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4292 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4293 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4294 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4295
4296 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4297 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4298 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4299 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4300 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4301 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4302 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4303 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4304 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4305
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004306 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4307 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4308 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4309 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4310 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4311 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4312 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4313 response header" for more information.
4314
4315 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4316 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4317 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4318 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4319 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004320 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4321 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004322
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004323 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4324 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4325 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4326 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4327 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4328 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4329
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004330 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4331 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4332 inline.
4333
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004334 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4335 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004339 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004341 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004342 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4343 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004344 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004345 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4346 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004347
4348 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4349 followed by some converters.
4350
4351 Example:
4352
4353 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4354
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004355 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4356 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4357
4358 Example:
4359
4360 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4361
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004362 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4363 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4364 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4365 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4366 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4367 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4368 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4369
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004370 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4371 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4372 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4373 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4374 continues.
4375
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004376 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4377 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4378 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4379 the actions evaluation continues.
4380
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004381 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4382 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4383 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4384 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4385 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4386 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4387 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4388 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4389 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4390 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4391 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4392 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4393 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4394 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4395 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4396 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4397
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004398 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4399
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004400 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004401 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4402 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004403 rules.
4404
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004405 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4406 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4407 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4408 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4409
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004410 Example:
4411 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4412
4413 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4414
4415 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4416 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4417
4418 Example:
4419 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4420
4421 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4422
4423 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4424 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4425
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004426 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4427 ACL usage.
4428
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004429
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004430http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4431 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4432
4433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4434 yes | no | yes | yes
4435
4436 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4437 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4438 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4439 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4440 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4441 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4442
4443 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4444
4445 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4446 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4447 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4448 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4449 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4450 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4451 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4452 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4453 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4454 not checking any request past the first one.
4455
4456 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4457 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4458 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4459 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4460 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4461 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4462 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4463
4464 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4465 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4466 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4467 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4468 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4469 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4470 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4471 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4472 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4473 downsides of rare connection failures.
4474
4475 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4476 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4477 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4478 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4479 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4480 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4481 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4482 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4483 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4484 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4485 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4486 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4487
4488 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4489 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4490 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4491 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4492
4493 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4494 and are never shared ;
4495
4496 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4497 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4498 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4499 and are never shared ;
4500
4501 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4502 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4503 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4504
4505 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4506 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4507 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4508
4509 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4510
4511
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004512http-send-name-header [<header>]
4513 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4514
4515 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 yes | no | yes | yes
4517
4518 Arguments :
4519
4520 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4521
4522 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4523 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4524 is added with the header string proved.
4525
4526 See also : "server"
4527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004528id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004529 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 no | yes | yes | yes
4532 Arguments : none
4533
4534 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4535 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4536 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004537
4538
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004539ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4540 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 no | yes | yes | yes
4543
4544 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4545 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4546 and running).
4547
4548 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4549 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4550 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004551 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004552 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4553
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004554 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4555 "unless" condition is met.
4556
4557 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4558
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004559load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4560 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | no | yes | yes
4563
4564 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4565 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4566 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4567 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4568 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4569 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4570 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4571 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4572
4573 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4574 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004575 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004576
4577 Arguments:
4578 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4579 named "server-state-file".
4580
4581 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4582 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4583 name is used as a file name.
4584
4585 none don't load any stat for this backend
4586
4587 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004588 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4589 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4590 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4591 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4592 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004593
4594 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4595 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4596
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004597 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004598
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004599 global
4600 stats socket /tmp/socket
4601 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004602
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004603 defaults
4604 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004605
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004606 backend bk
4607 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4608 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004609
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004610
4611 Then one can run :
4612
4613 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4614
4615 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4616
4617 1
4618 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4619 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4620 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4621
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004622 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004623
4624 global
4625 stats socket /tmp/socket
4626 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4627
4628 defaults
4629 load-server-state-from-file local
4630
4631 backend bk
4632 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4633 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4634
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004635
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004636 Then one can run :
4637
4638 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4639
4640 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4641
4642 1
4643 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4644 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4645 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4646
4647 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4648 "show servers state"
4649
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004650
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004651log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004652log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004653no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004654 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4656 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004657
4658 Prefix :
4659 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4660 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4661 prefix does not allow arguments.
4662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004663 Arguments :
4664 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4665 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4666 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4667 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4668 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4669 parameter.
4670
4671 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4672 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4673
4674 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4675 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4676 standard syslog port).
4677
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004678 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4679 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4680 standard syslog port).
4681
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004682 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4683 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4684 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4685 appropriately writeable).
4686
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004687 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4688 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004689
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004690 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4691 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4692 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4693 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4694 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4695 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4696 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4697 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4698 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4699 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4700 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4703
4704 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4705 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4706 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4707
4708 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4709 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4710 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004711 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4712 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4713 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4714 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4715 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004716
4717 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4718
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004719 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4720 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4721 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004722
4723 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4724 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4725 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4726 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4727
4728 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4729 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730
4731 Example :
4732 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004733 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4734 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004738log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004739 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004742
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004743 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4744 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4745 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4746 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4747 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004748
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004749log-format-sd <string>
4750 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | yes | yes | no
4753
4754 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4755 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4756 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4757 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4758 which covers the log format string in depth.
4759
4760 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4761 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4762
4763 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4764 log format to "rfc5424".
4765
4766 Example :
4767 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4768
4769
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004770log-tag <string>
4771 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | yes
4774
4775 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4776 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4777 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4778 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4779 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4780 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4781 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4782 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4783 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004784
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004785max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4786 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4788 yes | no | yes | yes
4789
4790 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4791 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4792 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4793 servers.
4794
4795 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4796 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4797 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4798 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4799 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4800 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4801 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4802 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4803 picking a different server.
4804
4805 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4806 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4807 even if they have to be queued.
4808
4809 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4810 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4811
4812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004813maxconn <conns>
4814 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 yes | yes | yes | no
4817 Arguments :
4818 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4819 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4820 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4821 closes.
4822
4823 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4824 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4825 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4826 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004827 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4828 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4829 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4830 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004831
4832 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4833 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4834 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4835
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004836 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4839
4840
4841mode { tcp|http|health }
4842 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4844 yes | yes | yes | yes
4845 Arguments :
4846 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4847 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4848 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4849 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4850
4851 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4852 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4853 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4854 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4855 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4856
4857 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004858 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4859 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4860 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4861 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4862 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4863 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4864 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004866 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4867 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4868 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004870 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004871 defaults http_instances
4872 mode http
4873
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004874 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004876
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004877monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004878 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004881 Arguments :
4882 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4883 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004884 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004885 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4886 backend and its backup.
4887
4888 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4889 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4890 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4891 servers in a list of backends.
4892
4893 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4894 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4895 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4896 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4897 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4898 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4899 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004900 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4901 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004902
4903 Example:
4904 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004906 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4907 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4908 monitor-uri /site_alive
4909 monitor fail if site_dead
4910
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004911 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004912
4913
4914monitor-net <source>
4915 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 yes | yes | yes | no
4918 Arguments :
4919 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4920 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4921 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4922 followed by a mask.
4923
4924 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4925 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004926 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004927 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4928
4929 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4930 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4931 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4932 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004933 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4934 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4935 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004936
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004937 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4938 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4939 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4940 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4941 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4942 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004944 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4945 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004946
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004947 Example :
4948 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4949 frontend www
4950 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4951
4952 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4953
4954
4955monitor-uri <uri>
4956 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | no
4959 Arguments :
4960 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4961 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4962
4963 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4964 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4965 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4966 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4967 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4968 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4969 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4970 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4971
4972 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4973 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4974 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4975 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4976 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4977 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4978
4979 Example :
4980 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4981 frontend www
4982 mode http
4983 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4984
4985 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004987
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004988option abortonclose
4989no option abortonclose
4990 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4992 yes | no | yes | yes
4993 Arguments : none
4994
4995 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4996 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4997 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4998 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004999 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005000 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5001 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5002 encountered while delivering the response.
5003
5004 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5005 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5006 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5007 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5008 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5009 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005010 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005011 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005012 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005013 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5014 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5015 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5016
5017 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5018 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5019 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5020 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5021 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5022 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5023 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5024 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005025 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005026
5027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5029
5030 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5031
5032
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005033option accept-invalid-http-request
5034no option accept-invalid-http-request
5035 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | no
5038 Arguments : none
5039
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005040 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005041 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5042 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5043 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5044 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5045 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5046 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5047 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005048 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5049 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5050 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5051 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5052 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005053 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005054 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5055 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5056 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005057
5058 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5059 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5060 been confirmed.
5061
5062 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5063 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005064 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5065 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005066 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5067
5068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5070
5071 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5072 stats socket.
5073
5074
5075option accept-invalid-http-response
5076no option accept-invalid-http-response
5077 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | no | yes | yes
5080 Arguments : none
5081
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005082 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005083 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5084 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5085 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5086 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5087 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5088 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5089 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005090 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5091 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5092 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005093
5094 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5095 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5096 been confirmed.
5097
5098 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5099 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5100 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5101 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5102
5103 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5104 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5105
5106 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5107 stats socket.
5108
5109
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005110option allbackups
5111no option allbackups
5112 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | no | yes | yes
5115 Arguments : none
5116
5117 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5118 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5119 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5120 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5121 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5122 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5123 order between the backup servers anymore.
5124
5125 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5126 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5127
5128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5130
5131
5132option checkcache
5133no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005134 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | no | yes | yes
5137 Arguments : none
5138
5139 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5140 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005141 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005142 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5143 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005144 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005145
5146 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005147 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005148 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005149 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5150 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005151 to the client are :
5152 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005153 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005154 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005155 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5156 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5157 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5158 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5159 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5160 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5161 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5162 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5163 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5165 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5166
5167 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005168 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005169 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005170 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005171 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5172
5173 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5174 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005175 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005176 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5177
5178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5180
5181
5182option clitcpka
5183no option clitcpka
5184 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5186 yes | yes | yes | no
5187 Arguments : none
5188
5189 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5190 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5191 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5192 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5193
5194 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5195 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5196 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5197 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5198
5199 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5200 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5201 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5202 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5203 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5204
5205 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5206
5207 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5208 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5209 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5210
5211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5213
5214 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5215
5216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005217option contstats
5218 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | yes | yes | no
5221 Arguments : none
5222
5223 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5224 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5225 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5226 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005227 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5228 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5229 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5230 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5231 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005232
5233
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005234option dontlog-normal
5235no option dontlog-normal
5236 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 yes | yes | yes | no
5239 Arguments : none
5240
5241 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5242 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5243 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5244 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5245 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5246 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5247 logged.
5248
5249 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5250 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5251 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005253 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005254 logging.
5255
5256
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005257option dontlognull
5258no option dontlognull
5259 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5261 yes | yes | yes | no
5262 Arguments : none
5263
5264 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5265 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5266 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5267 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5268 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5269 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005270 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5271 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5272 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005273
5274 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5275 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5276 would not be logged.
5277
5278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5280
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005281 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5282 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005283
5284
5285option forceclose
5286no option forceclose
5287 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005289 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005290 Arguments : none
5291
5292 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5293 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5294 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5295 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5296 global session times in the logs.
5297
5298 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005299 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005300 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005301
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005302 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5303 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5304 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5305
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005306 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5307 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005308
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5311
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005312 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005313
5314
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005315option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005316 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | yes | yes | yes
5319 Arguments :
5320 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5321 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005322 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005323 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005324
5325 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5326 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5327 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5328 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5329 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5330 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5331 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005332 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5333 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5334 possible that the client has already brought one.
5335
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005336 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005337 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005338 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5339 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005340 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5341 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005342
5343 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5344 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5345 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5346 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5347 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5348 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5349 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5350
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005351 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5352 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5353 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5354 are under the control of the end-user.
5355
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005356 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005357 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5358 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005359 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5360 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5361 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005362
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005363 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005364 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5365 frontend www
5366 mode http
5367 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5368
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005369 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5370 backend www
5371 mode http
5372 option forwardfor header X-Client
5373
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005374 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005375 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005376
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005377
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005378option http-buffer-request
5379no option http-buffer-request
5380 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | yes
5383 Arguments : none
5384
5385 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5386 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5387 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5388 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5389 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5390 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5391 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5392 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005393 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005394 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5395 default.
5396
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005397 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005398
5399
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005400option http-ignore-probes
5401no option http-ignore-probes
5402 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5404 yes | yes | yes | no
5405 Arguments : none
5406
5407 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5408 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5409 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5410 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5411 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5412 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5413 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5414 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5415 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5416 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5417 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5418 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5419
5420 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5421 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5422 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5423 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5424 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5425 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5426 are often the only way to detect them.
5427
5428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5430
5431 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5432
5433
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005434option http-keep-alive
5435no option http-keep-alive
5436 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5438 yes | yes | yes | yes
5439 Arguments : none
5440
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005441 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5442 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5443 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5444 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5445 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5446 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5447 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5448
5449 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5450 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005451 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5452 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5453 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5454 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5455 situations where this option may be useful :
5456
5457 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5458 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5459
5460 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5461 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5462
5463 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5464 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5465 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5466 request.
5467
5468 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5469 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005470 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5471 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5472 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005473
5474 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5475 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5476
5477 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5478 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5479 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5480 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5481 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5482 not set.
5483
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005484 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5485 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005486 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005487 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005488
5489 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005490 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5491 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005492
5493
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005494option http-no-delay
5495no option http-no-delay
5496 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5498 yes | yes | yes | yes
5499 Arguments : none
5500
5501 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5502 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5503 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5504 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5505 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5506 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5507 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5508 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5509 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5510 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5511 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5512 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5513 affected.
5514
5515 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5516 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5517 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5518 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5519 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5520 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5521 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5522 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5523 latency environments.
5524
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005525 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5526
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005527
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005528option http-pretend-keepalive
5529no option http-pretend-keepalive
5530 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5532 yes | yes | yes | yes
5533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5536 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5537 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5538 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5539 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5540 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5541 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5542 consider the response complete.
5543
5544 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5545 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5546 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5547 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5548 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5549 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5550
5551 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5552 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5553 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5554 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5555 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5556 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5557 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5558
5559 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5560 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005561 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005562 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5563 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005564
5565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5567
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005568 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5569 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005570
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005571
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005572option http-server-close
5573no option http-server-close
5574 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5576 yes | yes | yes | yes
5577 Arguments : none
5578
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005579 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5580 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5581 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5582 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5583 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5584 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5585 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5586 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5587 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5588 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5589 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5590 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5591 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5592 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5593 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5594 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005595
5596 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5597 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5598 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5599 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005600 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5601 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005602
5603 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5604 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005605 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5606 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005607 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5608 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005609
5610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5612
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005613 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005614 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5615 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005616
5617
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005618option http-tunnel
5619no option http-tunnel
5620 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | yes | yes | yes
5623 Arguments : none
5624
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005625 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5626 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5627 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5628 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5629 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5630 "option http-tunnel".
5631
5632 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005633 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005634 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5635 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5636 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5637 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5638 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5639 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5640 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005641
5642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5644
5645 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5646 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5647 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5648
5649
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005650option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005651no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005652 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5654 yes | yes | yes | no
5655 Arguments : none
5656
5657 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5658 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5659 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5660 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5661 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5662 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5663 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5664
5665 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5666 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005667 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5668 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5669 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005670
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005671 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5672 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5673 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5674 front of an existing proxy.
5675
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005676 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5677
5678 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5679 http-server-close".
5680
5681
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005682option httpchk
5683option httpchk <uri>
5684option httpchk <method> <uri>
5685option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5686 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | no | yes | yes
5689 Arguments :
5690 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5691 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5692 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5693 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5694 ones.
5695
5696 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5697 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5698 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5699
5700 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5701 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5702 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5703 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5704 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5705
5706 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5707 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5708 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5709 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5710 the lack of any response.
5711
5712 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5713
5714 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5715 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5716 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5717
5718 Examples :
5719 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5720 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5721 backend https_relay
5722 mode tcp
5723 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5724 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5725
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005726 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5727 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5728 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005729
5730
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005731option httpclose
5732no option httpclose
5733 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 yes | yes | yes | yes
5736 Arguments : none
5737
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005738 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5739 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5740 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5741 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005742 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005743 "option http-tunnel".
5744
5745 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5746 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5747 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5748 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5749 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5750 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5751 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5752 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005753
5754 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005755 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005756 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5757 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5758 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5759 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5760 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005761
5762 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5763 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005764 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5765 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005766 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5767 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005768
5769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5771
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005772 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5773 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005774
5775
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005776option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005777 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005780 Arguments :
5781 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5782 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5783 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5784 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5785 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005786
5787 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5788 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5789 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5790 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5791 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5792 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5793 ports.
5794
5795 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5796
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005797 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5798 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005800 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005801
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005802
5803option http_proxy
5804no option http_proxy
5805 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5807 yes | yes | yes | yes
5808 Arguments : none
5809
5810 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5811 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5812 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5813 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5814 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5815
5816 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5817 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005818 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5819 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005820
5821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5823
5824 Example :
5825 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5826 backend direct_forward
5827 option httpclose
5828 option http_proxy
5829
5830 See also : "option httpclose"
5831
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005832
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005833option independent-streams
5834no option independent-streams
5835 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | yes | yes | yes
5838 Arguments : none
5839
5840 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5841 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5842 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5843 receive data or not.
5844
5845 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5846 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5847 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5848 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5849 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5850 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5851 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5852 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5853 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5854 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5855 socket buffers.
5856
5857 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5858 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5859 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5860 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5861 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5862
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005863 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005864 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5865 deprecated.
5866
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005867 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005868
5869
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005870option ldap-check
5871 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5873 yes | no | yes | yes
5874 Arguments : none
5875
5876 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5877 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5878 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5879 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5880
5881 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5882 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5883
5884 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5885 configure it.
5886
5887 Example :
5888 option ldap-check
5889
5890 See also : "option httpchk"
5891
5892
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005893option external-check
5894 Use external processes for server health checks
5895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | no | yes | yes
5897
5898 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5899 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5900 command".
5901
5902 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5903
5904 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5905
5906
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005907option log-health-checks
5908no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005909 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5911 yes | no | yes | yes
5912 Arguments : none
5913
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005914 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5915 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5916 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005917
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005918 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5919 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5920 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5921 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5922 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5923
5924 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5925 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005926
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005927 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5928 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5929 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005930
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005931
5932option log-separate-errors
5933no option log-separate-errors
5934 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | yes | yes | no
5937 Arguments : none
5938
5939 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5940 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5941 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5942 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5943 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5944 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5945 provides very important information.
5946
5947 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5948 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5949 error logs.
5950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005951 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005952 logging.
5953
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005954
5955option logasap
5956no option logasap
5957 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 yes | yes | yes | no
5960 Arguments : none
5961
5962 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5963 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5964 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5965 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5966 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5967 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5968 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005969 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005970 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5971 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5972
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005973 Examples :
5974 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5975 mode http
5976 option httplog
5977 option logasap
5978 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5979
5980 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5981 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5982 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5983 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005985 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005986 logging.
5987
5988
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005989option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005990 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5992 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005993 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005994 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5995 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005996 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005997
5998 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5999 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6000 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6001 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6002 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6003 in the MySQL table, like this :
6004
6005 USE mysql;
6006 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6007 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6008
6009 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6010 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6011 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6012 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6013 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6014 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6015 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6016 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6017 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6018
6019 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6020 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006021
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006022 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006023
6024 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6025 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6026 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6027 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006028 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6029 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006030
6031 See also: "option httpchk"
6032
6033
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006034option nolinger
6035no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006036 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006039 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006040
6041 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6042 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6043 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6044 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6045 connections.
6046
6047 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6048 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6049 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6050 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6051 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6052 this too.
6053
6054 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6055 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6056 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6057
6058 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6059 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6060 for servers.
6061
6062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6064
6065
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006066option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6067 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6069 yes | yes | yes | yes
6070 Arguments :
6071 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6072 matching <network>
6073 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6074 header name.
6075
6076 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6077 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6078 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6079 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6080 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6081 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6082 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6083 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6084 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6085 possible that the client has already brought one.
6086
6087 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6088 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6089 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6090 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6091 header and requires different one.
6092
6093 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6094 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6095 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6096 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6097 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6098 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6099 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6100
6101 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6102 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6103 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6104 both are defined.
6105
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006106 Examples :
6107 # Original Destination address
6108 frontend www
6109 mode http
6110 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6111
6112 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6113 backend www
6114 mode http
6115 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6116
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006117 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6118 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006119
6120
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006121option persist
6122no option persist
6123 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006126 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006127
6128 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6129 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6130 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6131 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6132 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6133 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6134 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6135 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6136 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6137 redirected to another valid server.
6138
6139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6141
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006142 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006143
6144
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006145option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6146 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | no | yes | yes
6149 Arguments :
6150 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6151 PostgreSQL server.
6152
6153 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6154 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6155 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6156 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6157
6158 See also: "option httpchk"
6159
6160
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006161option prefer-last-server
6162no option prefer-last-server
6163 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 yes | no | yes | yes
6166 Arguments : none
6167
6168 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6169 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6170 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6171 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6172 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6173 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6174 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6175 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6176 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006177 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6178 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6179 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6180 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6181 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6182 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6183 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006184
6185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6187
6188 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6189
6190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006191option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006192option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006193no option redispatch
6194 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6196 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006197 Arguments :
6198 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6199 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6200 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6201 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6202 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6203 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6204 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6205 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6206 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006208
6209 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6210 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6211 be able to access the service anymore.
6212
6213 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6214 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6215
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006216 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006217 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6218 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006220 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6221 "redisp" keywords.
6222
6223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6225
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006226 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006227
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006228
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006229option redis-check
6230 Use redis health checks for server testing
6231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6232 yes | no | yes | yes
6233 Arguments : none
6234
6235 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6236 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6237 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6238 find the "+PONG" response message.
6239
6240 Example :
6241 option redis-check
6242
6243 See also : "option httpchk"
6244
6245
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006246option smtpchk
6247option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6248 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6250 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006251 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006252 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6253 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6254 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6255
6256 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6257 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6258 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6259
6260 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6261 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6262 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6263 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6264 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6265 dead server.
6266
6267 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6268 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6269 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6270 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6271
6272 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6273 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6274 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6275 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006276 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006277
6278 Example :
6279 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6280
6281 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006284option socket-stats
6285no option socket-stats
6286
6287 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | yes | yes | no
6290
6291 Arguments : none
6292
6293
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006294option splice-auto
6295no option splice-auto
6296 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6298 yes | yes | yes | yes
6299 Arguments : none
6300
6301 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6302 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6303 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6304 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006305 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006306 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6307 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6308 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6309 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6310
6311 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6312 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6313 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6314 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6315 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6316 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6317 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6318 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6319 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6320 keyword.
6321
6322 Example :
6323 option splice-auto
6324
6325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6327
6328 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6329 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6330
6331
6332option splice-request
6333no option splice-request
6334 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6336 yes | yes | yes | yes
6337 Arguments : none
6338
6339 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006340 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006341 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6342 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6343 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6344 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6345
6346 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6347
6348 Example :
6349 option splice-request
6350
6351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6353
6354 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6355 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6356
6357
6358option splice-response
6359no option splice-response
6360 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6362 yes | yes | yes | yes
6363 Arguments : none
6364
6365 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006366 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006367 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6368 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6369 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6370 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6371
6372 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6373
6374 Example :
6375 option splice-response
6376
6377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6379
6380 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6381 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6382
6383
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006384option spop-check
6385 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 no | no | no | yes
6388 Arguments : none
6389
6390 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6391 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6392 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6393 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6394
6395 Example :
6396 option spop-check
6397
6398 See also : "option httpchk"
6399
6400
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006401option srvtcpka
6402no option srvtcpka
6403 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | no | yes | yes
6406 Arguments : none
6407
6408 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6409 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6410 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6411 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6412
6413 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6414 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6415 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6416 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6417
6418 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6419 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6420 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6421 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6422 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6423
6424 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6425
6426 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6427 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6428 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6429
6430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6432
6433 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6434
6435
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006436option ssl-hello-chk
6437 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6439 yes | no | yes | yes
6440 Arguments : none
6441
6442 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6443 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6444 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6445 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6446 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6447 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6448 hello message.
6449
6450 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6451 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6452 messages, which is appreciable.
6453
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006454 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6455 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6456 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006457
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006458 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6459
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006460
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006461option tcp-check
6462 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | no | yes | yes
6465
6466 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6467 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6468
6469 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6470 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6471 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6472
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006473 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006474 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6475 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6476 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6477 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6478 only.
6479
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006480 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006481 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6482 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6483 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6484 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006486 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006487 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6488 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006489 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006490 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6491 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6492 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6493 the respective protocols.
6494 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6495 analysed.
6496
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006497 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6498 script.
6499
6500 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6501 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6502 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6503 The "comment" is of course optional.
6504
6505
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006506 Examples :
6507 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6508 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006509 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006510
6511 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6512 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006513 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006514
6515 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6516 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006517 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006518 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006519 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006520 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006521 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006522 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006523 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6524 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006525 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006526 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6527 tcp-check expect string +OK
6528
6529 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6530 (send many headers before analyzing)
6531 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006532 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006533 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6534 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6535 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6536 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006537 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006538
6539
6540 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6541
6542
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006543option tcp-smart-accept
6544no option tcp-smart-accept
6545 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6547 yes | yes | yes | no
6548 Arguments : none
6549
6550 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6551 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6552 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6553 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6554 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6555 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6556
6557 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6558 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6559 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6560 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6561
6562 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6563 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6564 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6565 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6566
6567 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6568 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6569 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6570
6571 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6572 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6573 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6574
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006575 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6576
6577
6578option tcp-smart-connect
6579no option tcp-smart-connect
6580 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6582 yes | no | yes | yes
6583 Arguments : none
6584
6585 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6586 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6587 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6588 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6589 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6590
6591 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6592 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6593 complex.
6594
6595 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6596 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6597 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6598
6599 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6600 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6601
6602 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6603
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006604
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006605option tcpka
6606 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | yes | yes | yes
6609 Arguments : none
6610
6611 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6612 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6613 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6614 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6615
6616 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6617 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6618 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6619 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6620
6621 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6622 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6623 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6624 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6625 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6626
6627 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6628
6629 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6630 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6631 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6632 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6633 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6634 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6635 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6636 backends.
6637
6638 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6639
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006640
6641option tcplog
6642 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6644 yes | yes | yes | yes
6645 Arguments : none
6646
6647 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6648 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6649 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6650 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6651 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6652 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6653 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6654 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6655
6656 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006658 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006659
6660
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006661option transparent
6662no option transparent
6663 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006665 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6669 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6670 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6671 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6672 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6673 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6674 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6675 appropriate server.
6676
6677 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6678 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6679
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006680 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006681 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006682
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006683
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006684external-check command <command>
6685 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | no | yes | yes
6688
6689 Arguments :
6690 <command> is the external command to run
6691
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006692 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6693
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006694 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006695
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006696 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6697 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6698 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6699 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6700 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6701 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006702
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006703 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6704
6705 Environment variables :
6706 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6707 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6708
6709 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6710
6711 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6712
6713 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6714 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6715 for a UNIX socket).
6716
6717 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6718
6719 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6720
6721 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6722
6723 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6724
6725 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6726
6727 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6728 socket).
6729
6730 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6731 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6732
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006733 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6734 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6735 failed.
6736
6737 Example :
6738 external-check command /bin/true
6739
6740 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6741
6742
6743external-check path <path>
6744 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | no | yes | yes
6747
6748 Arguments :
6749 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6750
6751 The default path is "".
6752
6753 Example :
6754 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6755
6756 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6757 "external-check command"
6758
6759
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006760persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006761persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006762 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 yes | no | yes | yes
6765 Arguments :
6766 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006767 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6768 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006769
6770 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6771 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6772 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6773 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6774 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6775 forwarded to this server.
6776
6777 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6778 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6779 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006780 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006781 a single "listen" section.
6782
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006783 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6784 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6785 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6786
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006787 Example :
6788 listen tse-farm
6789 bind :3389
6790 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6791 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6792 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6793 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6794 persist rdp-cookie
6795 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006796 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006797 balance rdp-cookie
6798 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6799 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6800
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006801 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6802 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006803
6804
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006805rate-limit sessions <rate>
6806 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6808 yes | yes | yes | no
6809 Arguments :
6810 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6811 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6812
6813 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6814 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6815 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6816 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6817 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6818 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6819
6820 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6821 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6822 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6823 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6824
6825 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6826 listen smtp
6827 mode tcp
6828 bind :25
6829 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006830 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006831
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006832 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6833 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6834 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006835
6836 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6837
6838
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006839redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6840redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6841redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006842 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 no | yes | yes | yes
6845
6846 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006847 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006848
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006849 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006850 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006851 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6852 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6853 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006854
6855 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6856 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6857 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6858 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6859 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006860 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6861 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6862 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6863 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006864
6865 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6866 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6867 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6868 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6869 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6870 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006871 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006872 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006873 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6874 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6875 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006876
6877 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006878 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6879 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6880 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006881 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006882 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6883 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6884 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6885 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006886
6887 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6888 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6889
6890 - "drop-query"
6891 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6892 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6893 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6894 with a location-type redirect.
6895
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006896 - "append-slash"
6897 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6898 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6899 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6900 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6901
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006902 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6903 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6904 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6905 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6906 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6907 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6908 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6909
6910 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6911 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6912 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6913 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6914 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6915 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6916 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006917
6918 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6919 acl clear dst_port 80
6920 acl secure dst_port 8080
6921 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006922 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006923 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006924 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6925
6926 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006927 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6928 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6929 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006930 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006931
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006932 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6933 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6934 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6935
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006936 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006937 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006938
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006939 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006940 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6941 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6942 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006944 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006945
6946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006947redisp (deprecated)
6948redispatch (deprecated)
6949 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006952 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006953
6954 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6955 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6956 be able to access the service anymore.
6957
6958 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6959 redistribute them to a working server.
6960
6961 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6962 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6963 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006965 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6966 "option redispatch" instead.
6967
6968 See also : "option redispatch"
6969
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006970
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006971reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006972 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6974 no | yes | yes | yes
6975 Arguments :
6976 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6977 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006978 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006979
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006980 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6981 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6982
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006983 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6984 the last header of an HTTP request.
6985
6986 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6987 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6988 responses.
6989
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006990 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6991 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6992 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6993
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006994 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6995 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006996
6997
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006998reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6999reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007000 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 no | yes | yes | yes
7003 Arguments :
7004 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7005 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7006 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7007 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7008 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7009 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7010 ignores case.
7011
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007012 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7013 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7014
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007015 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7016 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7017 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7018 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007019 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007020
7021 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7022 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7023
7024 Example :
7025 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7026 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7027 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7028
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007029 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7030 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007031
7032
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007033reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7034reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007035 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7037 no | yes | yes | yes
7038 Arguments :
7039 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7040 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7041 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7042 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7043 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7044 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7045
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007046 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7047 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7048
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007049 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7050 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7051 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7052 next servers.
7053
7054 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7055 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7056 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7057
7058 Example :
7059 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7060 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7061 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7062
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007063 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7064 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007065
7066
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007067reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7068reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007069 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7071 no | yes | yes | yes
7072 Arguments :
7073 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7074 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7075 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7076 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7077 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7078 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7079 case.
7080
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007081 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7082 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7083
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007084 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7085 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7086 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7087 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007088 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007089
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007090 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007091 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007092 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007093
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7095 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7096
7097 Example :
7098 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7099 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7100 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7101
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007102 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7103 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104
7105
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007106reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7107reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007108 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7110 no | yes | yes | yes
7111 Arguments :
7112 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7113 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7114 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7115 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7116 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7117 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7118 case.
7119
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007120 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7121 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7122
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007123 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7124 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7125 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7126 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7127
7128 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7129 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7130
7131 Example :
7132 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7133 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7134 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7135 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7136
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007137 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7138 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007139
7140
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007141reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7142reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007143 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 no | yes | yes | yes
7146 Arguments :
7147 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7148 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7149 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7150 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7151 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7152 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7153
7154 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7155 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7156 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7157 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007158 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007159
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007160 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7161 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7162
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007163 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7164 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7165 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7166
7167 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7168 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7169 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7170 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7171 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7172
7173 Example :
7174 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007175 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007176 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7177 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7178
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007179 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7180 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007181
7182
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007183reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7184reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007185 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7187 no | yes | yes | yes
7188 Arguments :
7189 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7190 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7191 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7192 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7193 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7194 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7195 ignores case.
7196
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007197 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7198 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7199
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007200 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7201 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007202 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7203 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7204 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007205 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7206 not set.
7207
7208 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7209 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7210 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7211 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7212 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7213
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007214 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007215 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7216 # block all others.
7217 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7218 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7219
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007220 # block bad guys
7221 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7222 reqitarpit . if badguys
7223
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007224 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7225 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226
7227
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007228retries <value>
7229 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7230 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 yes | no | yes | yes
7232 Arguments :
7233 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7234 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7235 default value is 3.
7236
7237 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7238 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7239 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7240
7241 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007242 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7243 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007244
7245 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7246 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7247
7248 See also : "option redispatch"
7249
7250
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007251rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007252 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7254 no | yes | yes | yes
7255 Arguments :
7256 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7257 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007258 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007259
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007260 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7261 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7262
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007263 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7264 the last header of an HTTP response.
7265
7266 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7267 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7268 responses.
7269
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007270 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7271 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007272
7273
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007274rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7275rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007276 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7278 no | yes | yes | yes
7279 Arguments :
7280 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7281 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7282 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7283 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7284 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7285 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7286 ignores case.
7287
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007288 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7289 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7290
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007291 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7292 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007293 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294 client.
7295
7296 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7297 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7298 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7299
7300 Example :
7301 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007302 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007303
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007304 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7305 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007306
7307
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007308rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7309rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007310 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7312 no | yes | yes | yes
7313 Arguments :
7314 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7315 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7316 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7317 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7318 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7319 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7320 ignores case.
7321
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007322 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7323 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7324
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007325 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7326 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7327 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7328 case-sensitive.
7329
7330 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007331 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7332 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7333 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007334
7335 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7336 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7337
7338 Example :
7339 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7340 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7341
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007342 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7343 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007344
7345
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007346rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7347rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007348 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 no | yes | yes | yes
7351 Arguments :
7352 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7353 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7354 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7355 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7356 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7357 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7358 ignores case.
7359
7360 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7361 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7362 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7363 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007364 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007365
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007366 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7367 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7368
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007369 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7370 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7371 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7372
7373 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7374 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7375 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7376 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7377 are not case-sensitive.
7378
7379 Example :
7380 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7381 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7382
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007383 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7384 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007385
7386
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007387server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007388 Declare a server in a backend
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 no | no | yes | yes
7391 Arguments :
7392 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007393 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007394 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007395
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007396 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7397 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7398 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7399 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007400 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7401 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7402 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7403 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7404 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007405 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7406 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7407 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7408 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7409 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7410 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7411 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007412 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007413 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7414 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007415 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7416 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007417
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007418 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007419 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7420 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7421 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7422 adding this value to the client's port.
7423
7424 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7425 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007426 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007427
7428 Examples :
7429 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7430 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007431 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007432 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7433 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7434 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007435
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007436 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7437 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7438 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7439 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7440 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7441
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007442 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7443 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007444
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007445server-state-file-name [<file>]
7446 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7447 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7448 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7449 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7450 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7451 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7452
7453 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7454 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7455
7456 global
7457 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7458
7459 backend bk
7460 load-server-state-from-file
7461
7462 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7463 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007464
7465source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007466source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007467source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007468 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7470 yes | no | yes | yes
7471 Arguments :
7472 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7473 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007474
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007475 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007476 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7477 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7478 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7479 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7480 supported prefixes are :
7481 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7482 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7483 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007484 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007485 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7486 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007487
7488 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7489 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007490 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7491 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7492 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007493
7494 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7495 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7496 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7497 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7498 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7499 <addr>.
7500
7501 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7502 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7503 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7504 port.
7505
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007506 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7507 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7508 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7509 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007510 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007511 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7512 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7513 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7514 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7515 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7516 HTTP header.
7517
7518 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7519 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007520 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007521 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7522 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7523 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7524 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7525 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7526 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7527 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7528
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007529 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7530 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7531 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7532 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7533 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7534 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7535
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007536 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7537 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7538 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7539 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7540
7541 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7542 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7543 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7544 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7545 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7546 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7547
7548 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7549 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7550 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7551 there are two methods :
7552
7553 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7554 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7555 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7556 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7557 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7558 of the client ranges may be used.
7559
7560 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7561 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7562 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7563 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7564 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7565 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7566 same session.
7567
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007568 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7569 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7570 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007571 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007572
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007573 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7574
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007575 Examples :
7576 backend private
7577 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7578 source 192.168.1.200
7579
7580 backend transparent_ssl1
7581 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7582 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7583
7584 backend transparent_ssl2
7585 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7586 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7587 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7588
7589 backend transparent_ssl3
7590 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7591 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7592 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7593
7594 backend transparent_smtp
7595 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7596 # with Tproxy version 4.
7597 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7598
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007599 backend transparent_http
7600 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7601 # proxy.
7602 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007604 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007605 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007607
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007608srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7609 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7611 yes | no | yes | yes
7612 Arguments :
7613 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7614 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7615 as explained at the top of this document.
7616
7617 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7618 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7619 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7620 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7621 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7622 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7623 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7624
7625 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7626 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7627 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7628 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7629 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007630 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007631 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007632 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007633
7634 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7635 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7636 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7637 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7638 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7639 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7640
7641 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7642 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7643
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007644 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7645 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007646
7647
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007648stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7649 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007651 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007652
7653 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7654 matched.
7655
7656 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7657 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7658
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007659 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7660 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7661 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7662
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007663 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7664 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7665 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7666 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007667
7668 Example :
7669 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7670 backend stats_localhost
7671 stats enable
7672 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7673
7674 Example :
7675 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7676 backend stats_auth
7677 stats enable
7678 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7679 stats admin if TRUE
7680
7681 Example :
7682 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7683 userlist stats-auth
7684 group admin users admin
7685 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7686 group readonly users haproxy
7687 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7688
7689 backend stats_auth
7690 stats enable
7691 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7692 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7693 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7694 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7695
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007696 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7697 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7698 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007699
7700
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007701stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7702 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007704 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007705 Arguments :
7706 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7707
7708 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7709
7710 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7711 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7712 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7713 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7714 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7715 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7716
7717 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7718 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7719 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007720 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007721
7722 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7723 report using "stats scope".
7724
7725 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7726 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7727 unobvious parameters.
7728
7729 Example :
7730 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7731 backend public_www
7732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7733 stats enable
7734 stats hide-version
7735 stats scope .
7736 stats uri /admin?stats
7737 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7738 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7739 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7740
7741 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7742 backend private_monitoring
7743 stats enable
7744 stats uri /admin?stats
7745 stats refresh 5s
7746
7747 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7748
7749
7750stats enable
7751 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007753 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007754 Arguments : none
7755
7756 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7757 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7758 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7759 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7760 - stats auth : no authentication
7761 - stats scope : no restriction
7762
7763 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7764 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7765 unobvious parameters.
7766
7767 Example :
7768 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7769 backend public_www
7770 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7771 stats enable
7772 stats hide-version
7773 stats scope .
7774 stats uri /admin?stats
7775 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7776 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7777 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7778
7779 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7780 backend private_monitoring
7781 stats enable
7782 stats uri /admin?stats
7783 stats refresh 5s
7784
7785 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7786
7787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007788stats hide-version
7789 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007791 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007792 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007793
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007794 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7795 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7796 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7797 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7798 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7799 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007801 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7802 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7803 unobvious parameters.
7804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007805 Example :
7806 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7807 backend public_www
7808 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007809 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007810 stats hide-version
7811 stats scope .
7812 stats uri /admin?stats
7813 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7814 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7815 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007816
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007817 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7818 backend private_monitoring
7819 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007820 stats uri /admin?stats
7821 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007822
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007823 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007824
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007825
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007826stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7827 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7828 Access control for statistics
7829
7830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7831 no | no | yes | yes
7832
7833 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7834 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7835 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7836 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7837 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7838 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7839
7840 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7841 instance.
7842
7843 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7844 about ACL usage.
7845
7846
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007847stats realm <realm>
7848 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007850 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007851 Arguments :
7852 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7853 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7854 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7855
7856 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7857 using a backslash ('\').
7858
7859 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7860 only related to authentication.
7861
7862 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7863 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7864 unobvious parameters.
7865
7866 Example :
7867 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7868 backend public_www
7869 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7870 stats enable
7871 stats hide-version
7872 stats scope .
7873 stats uri /admin?stats
7874 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7875 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7876 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7877
7878 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7879 backend private_monitoring
7880 stats enable
7881 stats uri /admin?stats
7882 stats refresh 5s
7883
7884 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7885
7886
7887stats refresh <delay>
7888 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007890 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007891 Arguments :
7892 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7893 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7894 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7895 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7896 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7897 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7898
7899 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7900 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7901 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7902 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7903
7904 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7905 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7906 unobvious parameters.
7907
7908 Example :
7909 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7910 backend public_www
7911 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7912 stats enable
7913 stats hide-version
7914 stats scope .
7915 stats uri /admin?stats
7916 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7917 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7918 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7919
7920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7921 backend private_monitoring
7922 stats enable
7923 stats uri /admin?stats
7924 stats refresh 5s
7925
7926 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7927
7928
7929stats scope { <name> | "." }
7930 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007932 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007933 Arguments :
7934 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7935 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7936 section in which the statement appears.
7937
7938 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7939 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7940 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7941 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7942 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7943 exists.
7944
7945 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7946 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7947 unobvious parameters.
7948
7949 Example :
7950 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7951 backend public_www
7952 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7953 stats enable
7954 stats hide-version
7955 stats scope .
7956 stats uri /admin?stats
7957 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7958 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7959 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7960
7961 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7962 backend private_monitoring
7963 stats enable
7964 stats uri /admin?stats
7965 stats refresh 5s
7966
7967 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7968
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007969
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007970stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007971 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007973 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007974
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007975 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007976 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7977
7978 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7979 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7980
7981 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7982 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007983 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007984
7985 Example :
7986 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7987 backend private_monitoring
7988 stats enable
7989 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7990 stats uri /admin?stats
7991 stats refresh 5s
7992
7993 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7994 global section.
7995
7996
7997stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007998 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8000 yes | yes | yes | yes
8001 Arguments : none
8002
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008003 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008004 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8005 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8006 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8007 - IP (socket, server)
8008 - cookie (backend, server)
8009
8010 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8011 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008012 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008013
8014 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8015
8016
8017stats show-node [ <name> ]
8018 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008020 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008021 Arguments:
8022 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8023 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8024
8025 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8026 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008027 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008028
8029 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8030 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8031 unobvious parameters.
8032
8033 Example:
8034 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8035 backend private_monitoring
8036 stats enable
8037 stats show-node Europe-1
8038 stats uri /admin?stats
8039 stats refresh 5s
8040
8041 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8042 section.
8043
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008044
8045stats uri <prefix>
8046 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008048 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008049 Arguments :
8050 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8051 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8052 query string.
8053
8054 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8055 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8056 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8057 possible to reach it in the application.
8058
8059 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008060 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008061 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8062 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8063 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8064 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8065
8066 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8067 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8068 an address or a port to statistics only.
8069
8070 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8071 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8072 unobvious parameters.
8073
8074 Example :
8075 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8076 backend public_www
8077 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8078 stats enable
8079 stats hide-version
8080 stats scope .
8081 stats uri /admin?stats
8082 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8083 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8084 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8085
8086 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8087 backend private_monitoring
8088 stats enable
8089 stats uri /admin?stats
8090 stats refresh 5s
8091
8092 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8093
8094
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008095stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8096 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008098 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008099
8100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008101 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008102 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8103 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8104 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8105
8106 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8107 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8108 the "stick-table" statement.
8109
8110 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8111 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8112 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8113 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8114 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8115
8116 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8117 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8118 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8119 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8120 transformation rules.
8121
8122 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8123 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8124 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8125 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8126 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8127 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8128 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8129
8130 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8131 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8132 ACL based conditions.
8133
8134 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8135 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8136 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8137 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8138
8139 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8140 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8141 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8142 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8143
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008144 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8145 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8146 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8147
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008148 Example :
8149 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8150 # last 30 minutes
8151 backend pop
8152 mode tcp
8153 balance roundrobin
8154 stick store-request src
8155 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8156 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8157 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8158
8159 backend smtp
8160 mode tcp
8161 balance roundrobin
8162 stick match src table pop
8163 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8164 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008166 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008167 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008168
8169
8170stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8171 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8173 no | no | yes | yes
8174
8175 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8176 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8177 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8178 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8179
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008180 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8181 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8182 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8183
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008184 Examples :
8185 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008186 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008187
8188 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8189 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8190 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8191
8192
8193 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8194 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8195 backend http
8196 mode http
8197 balance roundrobin
8198 stick on src table https
8199 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8200 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8201 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8202
8203 backend https
8204 mode tcp
8205 balance roundrobin
8206 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8207 stick on src
8208 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8209 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8210
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008211 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008212
8213
8214stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8215 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 no | no | yes | yes
8218
8219 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008220 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008221 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8222 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8223 server is selected.
8224
8225 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8226 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8227 the "stick-table" statement.
8228
8229 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8230 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8231 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8232 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8233 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8234 address.
8235
8236 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8237 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8238 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8239 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8240 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8241 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8242 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8243 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8244 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8245 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8246
8247 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8248 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8249 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8250 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8251 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8252 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8253 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8254
8255 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8256 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8257 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8258 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8259
8260 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8261 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8262 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8263 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8264 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8265 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008266 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8267 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8268 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8269 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8270 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8271 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008272
8273 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8274 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8275 the request.
8276
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008277 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8278 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8279 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8280
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008281 Example :
8282 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8283 # last 30 minutes
8284 backend pop
8285 mode tcp
8286 balance roundrobin
8287 stick store-request src
8288 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8289 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8290 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8291
8292 backend smtp
8293 mode tcp
8294 balance roundrobin
8295 stick match src table pop
8296 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8297 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8298
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008299 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008300 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008301
8302
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008303stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008304 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8305 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008306 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008308 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008309
8310 Arguments :
8311 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8312 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8313 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8314 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8315
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008316 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8317 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8318 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8319 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8320
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008321 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8322 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8323 instance.
8324
8325 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8326 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8327 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8328 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8329 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8330 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008331 to 32 characters.
8332
8333 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8334 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8335 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008336 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008337 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8338 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008339
8340 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008341 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8342 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008343 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8344 increase.
8345
8346 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008347 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8348 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8349 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008350
8351 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8352 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8353 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8354 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8355 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8356 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8357 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8358 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8359 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8360 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8361 parameter (see below).
8362
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008363 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8364 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8365 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8366 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8367 soft restart.
8368
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008369 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8370 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008371
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008372 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8373 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8374 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8375 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8376 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008377 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008378 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8379 if not expiration delay is specified.
8380
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008381 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8382 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8383 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8384 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008385 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8386 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8387 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8388 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8389 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8390 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8391 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8392 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8393 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8394 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8395 types and their arguments.
8396
8397 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8398 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8399 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8400 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8401
8402 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8403 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8404 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8405 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8406
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008407 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8408 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8409 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8410 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8411 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8412 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8413
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008414 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8415 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8416 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8417 they were received.
8418
8419 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8420 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8421 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8422 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8423 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8424
8425 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8426 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8427 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8428 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8429 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8430
8431 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8432 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8433 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8434
8435 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8436 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8437 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8438 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8439 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8440
8441 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8442 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8443 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8444 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8445 the client side.
8446
8447 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8448 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8449 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8450 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8451 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8452 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8453 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8454
8455 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8456 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8457 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8458 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8459 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8460 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8461 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8462
8463 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8464 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8465 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8466 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8467 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8468 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8469
8470 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8471 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8472 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8473 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8474
8475 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8476 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8477 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8478 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8479 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8480 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8481 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8482 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8483 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8484 recommended for better fairness.
8485
8486 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8487 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8488 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8489 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8490
8491 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8492 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8493 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8494 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8495 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8496 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8497 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8498 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8499 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8500 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008501
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008502 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8503 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008504 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8505 reference it.
8506
8507 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8508 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008509 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8510 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8511 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008512
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008513 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8514 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8515 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8516 something that can be ignored.
8517
8518 Example:
8519 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8520 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8521 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8522 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8523
8524 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008525 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008526
8527
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008528stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008529 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8531 no | no | yes | yes
8532
8533 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008534 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008535 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8536 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8537 server is selected.
8538
8539 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8540 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8541 the "stick-table" statement.
8542
8543 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8544 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8545 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8546 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8547
8548 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8549 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8550 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8551 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8552 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8553 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008554 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008555 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8556 rules.
8557
8558 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8559 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8560 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8561 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8562 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8563 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8564 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8565
8566 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8567 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8568 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8569 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8570
8571 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8572 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8573 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8574 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8575 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8576 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008577 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8578 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8579 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8580 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8581 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8582 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8583 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8584 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8585 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008586
8587 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8588
8589 Example :
8590 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8591 backend https
8592 mode tcp
8593 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008594 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008595 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008596
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008597 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8598 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8599
8600 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8601 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8602 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8603
8604 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8605 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008606
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008607 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8608 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8609 # at offset 44.
8610
8611 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8612 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8613
8614 # Learn on response if server hello.
8615 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008616
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008617 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8618 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8619
8620 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8621 extraction.
8622
8623
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008624tcp-check connect [params*]
8625 Opens a new connection
8626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 no | no | yes | yes
8628
8629 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8630 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8631 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8632
8633 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8634 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8635 of the sequence.
8636
8637 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8638 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8639 do.
8640
8641 Parameters :
8642 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8643 use the TCP connection.
8644
8645 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8646 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8647 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8648
8649 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8650
8651 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8652
8653 Examples:
8654 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8655 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8656 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8657 option tcp-check
8658 tcp-check connect
8659 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8660 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8661 tcp-check send \r\n
8662 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8663 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8664 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8665 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8666 tcp-check send \r\n
8667 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8668 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8669
8670 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8671 option tcp-check
8672 tcp-check connect port 110
8673 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8674 tcp-check connect port 143
8675 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8676 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8677
8678 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8679
8680
8681tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8682 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8684 no | no | yes | yes
8685
8686 Arguments :
8687 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8688 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8689 binary.
8690 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8691 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8692 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8693
8694 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8695 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8696 with the usual backslash ('\').
8697 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8698 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8699 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8700 used upper or lower case.
8701
8702
8703 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8704
8705 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8706 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8707 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8708 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8709 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8710 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8711 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8712 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8713
8714 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8715 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8716 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8717 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8718 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8719 expression.
8720
8721 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8722 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8723 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8724 this exact hexadecimal string.
8725 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8726
8727 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8728 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8729 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8730 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8731 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8732 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8733 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8734 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8735 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8736 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8737 the null character.
8738
8739 Examples :
8740 # perform a POP check
8741 option tcp-check
8742 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8743
8744 # perform an IMAP check
8745 option tcp-check
8746 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8747
8748 # look for the redis master server
8749 option tcp-check
8750 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008751 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008752 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8753 tcp-check expect string role:master
8754 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8755 tcp-check expect string +OK
8756
8757
8758 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8759 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8760
8761
8762tcp-check send <data>
8763 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8765 no | no | yes | yes
8766
8767 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8768 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8769
8770 Examples :
8771 # look for the redis master server
8772 option tcp-check
8773 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8774 tcp-check expect string role:master
8775
8776 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8777 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8778
8779
8780tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8781 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8782 tcp health check
8783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8784 no | no | yes | yes
8785
8786 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8787 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8788 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8789 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8790 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8791 hexadecimal string.
8792 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8793
8794 Examples :
8795 # redis check in binary
8796 option tcp-check
8797 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8798 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8799
8800
8801 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8802 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8803
8804
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008805tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8806 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8808 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008809 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008810 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8811 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008812
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008813 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008814
8815 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8816 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008817 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8818 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8819 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8820 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8821 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8822 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008824 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8825 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8826 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8827 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008828
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008829 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008830 - accept :
8831 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8832 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8833 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008835 - reject :
8836 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8837 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8838 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8839 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8840 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8841 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8842 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8843 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8844 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8845 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8846 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008847 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008848
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008849 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8850 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8851 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8852 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8853 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8854 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8855 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8856 hosts.
8857
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008858 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8859 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8860 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8861 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8862 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8863 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8864 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8865 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8866
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008867 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8868 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8869 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8870 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8871 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8872 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8873 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8874 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8875 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008876 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8877 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008878
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008879 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008880 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008881 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008882 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008883 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8884 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008885 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008886 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8887 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8888 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8889 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8890 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008892 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008893 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008894 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008895 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8896 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8897 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8898 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008900 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8901 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8902 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8903 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008905 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8906 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8907 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8908 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8909 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008910 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8911 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8912 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8913 layer7 information is extracted.
8914
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008915 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8916 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8917 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8918 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8919 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008920
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008921 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8922 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8923 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8924 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8925
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008926 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8927 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8928 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8929 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8930 continues.
8931
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008932 - set-src <expr> :
8933 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8934 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8935 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8936 set-src"
8937
8938 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8939 followed by some converters.
8940
8941 Example:
8942
8943 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8944
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008945 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8946 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008947
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008948 - set-src-port <expr> :
8949 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8950 expression.
8951
8952 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8953 followed by some converters.
8954
8955 Example:
8956
8957 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8958
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008959 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8960 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8961 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008962
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008963 - set-dst <expr> :
8964 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8965 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8966 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8967 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8968 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8969
8970 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8971 followed by some converters.
8972
8973 Example:
8974
8975 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8976 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8977
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008978 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8979 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8980
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008981 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8982 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8983 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8984 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8985
8986
8987 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8988 followed by some converters.
8989
8990 Example:
8991
8992 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8993
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008994 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8995 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8996 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8997
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008998 - "silent-drop" :
8999 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9000 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9001 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9002 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9003 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9004 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9005 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9006 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9007 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9008 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9009 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9010 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9011 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9012 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9013 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9014 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009016 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9017 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9018 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009020 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9021 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9022 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009024 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009025 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009026 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009028 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9029 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9030 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009032 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009033 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9034 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009035
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009036 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9037
9038 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9039
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9041
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009042 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009043
9044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009045tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9046 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009048 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009049 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009050 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9051 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009053 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009055 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9056 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9057 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9058 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9059 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009061 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9062 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9063 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9064 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009065 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9066 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9067 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9068 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9069 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9070 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009071 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009072 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009074 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9075 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9076 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9077 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009078
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009079 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009080 - accept : the request is accepted
9081 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9082 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009083 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009084 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009085 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009086 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009087 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009088 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009090 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9091 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009092
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009093 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9094 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9095 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9096 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9097 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9098 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009100 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009101 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9102 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009105 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9106 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9107 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9108 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009109 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9110 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9111 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009112
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009113 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009114 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9115 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9116 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009117
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009118 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009119 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9120 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009121
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009122 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9123 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009124 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009125 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9126 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009127 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009128 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009129 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009130 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9131 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009132 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009133 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9134 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009135
9136 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9137 followed by some converters.
9138
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009139 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9140 <var-name>.
9141
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009142 Example:
9143
9144 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009145 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009146
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009147 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009148 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9149 # and reject everything else.
9150 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9151 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009152 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009153 tcp-request content reject
9154
9155 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009156 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9157 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9158 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009159 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009160
9161 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9162 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9163 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009164 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009165 tcp-request content reject
9166
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009167 Example:
9168 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9169 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009170 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009171
9172 Example:
9173 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9174 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009175 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009177 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9178 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9179
9180 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009181 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009182 # protecting all our sites
9183 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009184 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9185 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009186 ...
9187 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9188
9189 backend http_dynamic
9190 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009191 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009192 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009193 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9194 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9195 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009196 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009198 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009199
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009200 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9201 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009202
9203
9204tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9205 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009207 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009208 Arguments :
9209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9211 as explained at the top of this document.
9212
9213 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9214 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9215 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9216 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9217 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9218
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009219 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9220 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9221 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9222 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9223
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009224 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9225 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009226 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009227 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009228 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9229 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9230 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9231 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009232
9233 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9234 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9235 it pass through unaffected.
9236
9237 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9238 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9239 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009240 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009241 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9242 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009243 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9244 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9245 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009246
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009247 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009248 "timeout client".
9249
9250
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009251tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9252 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9254 no | no | yes | yes
9255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009256 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9257 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009258
9259 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9260
9261 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9262 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9263 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009264 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9265 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009266
9267 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9268
9269 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9270 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9271 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9272 inserted.
9273
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009274 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009275 - accept :
9276 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9277 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9278 the rules evaluation.
9279
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009280 - close :
9281 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9282 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9283 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9284 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9285 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9286 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009287 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009288 protocols.
9289
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009290 - reject :
9291 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9292 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009293 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009294
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009295 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9296 Sets a variable.
9297
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009298 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9299 Unsets a variable.
9300
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009301 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9302 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9303 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9304 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9305
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009306 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9307 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9308 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9309 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9310 continues.
9311
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009312 - "silent-drop" :
9313 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9314 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9315 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9316 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9317 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9318 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9319 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9320 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9321 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9322 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9323 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9324 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9325 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9326 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9327 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9328 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9329
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009330 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9331 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9332 for changing the default action to a reject.
9333
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009334 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9335 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9336 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9337 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009338 period.
9339
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009340 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9341 declared inline.
9342
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009343 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9344 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009345 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009346 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9347 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009348 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009349 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009350 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009351 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9352 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009354 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9355 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009356
9357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9358 followed by some converters.
9359
9360 Example:
9361
9362 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9363
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009364 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9365 <var-name>.
9366
9367 Example:
9368
9369 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9370
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009371 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9372
9373 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9374
9375
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009376tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9377 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 no | yes | yes | no
9380 Arguments :
9381 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9382 below.
9383
9384 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9385
9386 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9387 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9388 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9389 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9390 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9391 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9392 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9393 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9394 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9395 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9396 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9397 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9398 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9399 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9400 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9401 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9402 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9403 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9404 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9405 instead.
9406
9407 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9408 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9409 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9410 rules which may be inserted.
9411
9412 Several types of actions are supported :
9413 - accept : the request is accepted
9414 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9415 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9416 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9417 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9418 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009419 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009420 - silent-drop
9421
9422 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9423 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9424 sections for a complete description.
9425
9426 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9427 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9428 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9429
9430 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9431 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9432 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9433 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9434 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9435
9436 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9437 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9438
9439 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9440 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9441 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9442
9443 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9444 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9445 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9446
9447 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9448 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9449 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9450
9451 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9452 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9453 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9454
9455 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9456
9457 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9458
9459
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009460tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9461 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9463 no | no | yes | yes
9464 Arguments :
9465 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9466 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9467 as explained at the top of this document.
9468
9469 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9470
9471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009472timeout check <timeout>
9473 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9474 established.
9475
9476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9477 yes | no | yes | yes
9478 Arguments:
9479 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9480 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9481 as explained at the top of this document.
9482
9483 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9484 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9485 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9486 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009487 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9488 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9489 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009490
9491 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9492 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9493
9494 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9495 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009496 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009497
9498 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9499 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9500 forget about it.
9501
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009502 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9503 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009504
9505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009506timeout client <timeout>
9507timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9508 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9510 yes | yes | yes | no
9511 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9514 as explained at the top of this document.
9515
9516 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9517 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9518 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009519 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9520 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9521 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9522 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009523 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9524 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9525 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009526 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009527 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009528 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9529 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009530 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9531 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009532
9533 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9534 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9535 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9536 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9537 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9538 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9539
9540 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9541 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9542 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9543
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009544 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9545 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009546
9547
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009548timeout client-fin <timeout>
9549 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9551 yes | yes | yes | no
9552 Arguments :
9553 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9555 as explained at the top of this document.
9556
9557 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9558 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9559 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9560 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9561 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9562 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9563 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9564 down in one direction.
9565
9566 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9567 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9568 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9569
9570 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9571
9572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009573timeout connect <timeout>
9574timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9575 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9577 yes | no | yes | yes
9578 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009579 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009580 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9581 as explained at the top of this document.
9582
9583 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009584 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009585 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009586 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009587 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9588 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009589
9590 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9591 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9592 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9593 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9594 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9595 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9596
9597 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9598 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9599 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9600
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009601 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9602 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009603
9604
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009605timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9606 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9608 yes | yes | yes | yes
9609 Arguments :
9610 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9611 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9612 as explained at the top of this document.
9613
9614 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9615 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9616 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9617 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9618 once the request has started to present itself.
9619
9620 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9621 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9622 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9623 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9624 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9625
9626 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9627 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9628 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9629 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9630
9631 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9632 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9633 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9634 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9635 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009636 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009637
9638 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9639 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9640 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9641 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9642
9643 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9644
9645
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009646timeout http-request <timeout>
9647 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009649 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009650 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009651 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9653 as explained at the top of this document.
9654
9655 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9656 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9657 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9658 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9659 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9660 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9661 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009662 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9663 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9664 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9665 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9666 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009667 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9668 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009669
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009670 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9671 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9672 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9673 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9674 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009675 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009676
9677 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9678 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9679 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9680 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9681 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9682
9683 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009684 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9685 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9686 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009687
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009688 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009689 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009690
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009691
9692timeout queue <timeout>
9693 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9695 yes | no | yes | yes
9696 Arguments :
9697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9699 as explained at the top of this document.
9700
9701 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9702 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9703 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9704 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9705 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9706
9707 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9708 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9709 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9710 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9711
9712 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9713
9714
9715timeout server <timeout>
9716timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9717 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9719 yes | no | yes | yes
9720 Arguments :
9721 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9722 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9723 as explained at the top of this document.
9724
9725 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9726 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9727 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9728 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9729 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9730 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9731 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9732
9733 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9734 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9735 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9736 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9737 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009738 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009739 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009740 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9741 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9742 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9743 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009744
9745 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9746 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9747 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9748 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9749 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9750 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9751
9752 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9753 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9754 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9755
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009756 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009757
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009758
9759timeout server-fin <timeout>
9760 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9762 yes | no | yes | yes
9763 Arguments :
9764 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9766 as explained at the top of this document.
9767
9768 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9769 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9770 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9771 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9772 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9773 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9774 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9775 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9776 situations, it should not be needed.
9777
9778 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9779 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9780 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9781
9782 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9783
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009784
9785timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009786 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9788 yes | yes | yes | yes
9789 Arguments :
9790 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9792 as explained at the top of this document.
9793
9794 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9795 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9796 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9797
9798 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9799 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9800 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9801 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009802 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009803
9804 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9805
9806
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009807timeout tunnel <timeout>
9808 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9810 yes | no | yes | yes
9811 Arguments :
9812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9814 as explained at the top of this document.
9815
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009816 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009817 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9818 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9819 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9820 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9821 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9822 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9823 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9824 specified.
9825
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009826 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9827 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9828 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9829 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9830 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9831 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9832 state.
9833
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009834 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9835 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9836 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9837 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9838 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9839
9840 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9841 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9842 forget about it.
9843
9844 Example :
9845 defaults http
9846 option http-server-close
9847 timeout connect 5s
9848 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009849 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009850 timeout server 30s
9851 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9852
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009853 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009854
9855
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009856transparent (deprecated)
9857 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009859 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009860 Arguments : none
9861
9862 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9863 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9864 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9865 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9866 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9867 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9868 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9869 appropriate server.
9870
9871 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9872
9873 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9874 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9875
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009876 See also: "option transparent"
9877
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009878unique-id-format <string>
9879 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9881 yes | yes | yes | no
9882 Arguments :
9883 <string> is a log-format string.
9884
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009885 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9886 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9887 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9888 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009889
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009890 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9891 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9892 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9893 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9894 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9895 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9896 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9897 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009898
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009899 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9900 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009901
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009902 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009903
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009904 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009905
9906 will generate:
9907
9908 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9909
9910 See also: "unique-id-header"
9911
9912unique-id-header <name>
9913 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9915 yes | yes | yes | no
9916 Arguments :
9917 <name> is the name of the header.
9918
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009919 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9920 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009921
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009922 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009923
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009924 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009925 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9926
9927 will generate:
9928
9929 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9930
9931 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009932
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009933use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009934 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 no | yes | yes | no
9937 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009938 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9939 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009940
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009941 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9942 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009943
9944 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9945 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9946 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009947 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9948 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9949 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9950 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009951
9952 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9953 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9954 assign the backend.
9955
9956 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9957 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9958 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9959 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9960 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9961 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9962
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009963 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009964 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009965 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9966 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9967 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9968
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009969 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9970 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9971 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9972 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9973 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9974 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9975 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9976 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9977 cannot be forced from the request.
9978
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009979 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009980 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9981 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9982
9983 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9984 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009985
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009986
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009987use-server <server> if <condition>
9988use-server <server> unless <condition>
9989 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9991 no | no | yes | yes
9992 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009993 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009994
9995 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9996
9997 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9998 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9999 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10000
10001 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10002 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10003 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10004 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10005 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10006 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10007 matches will assign the server.
10008
10009 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10010 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10011 with the next rules until one matches.
10012
10013 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10014 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10015 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10016 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10017
10018 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10019 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10020 stripped.
10021
10022 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10023 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10024 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10025 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10026
10027 Example :
10028 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10029 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10030 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10031 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10032 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10033 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
10034 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
10035 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10036 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10037
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010038 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010039
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010040
100415. Bind and Server options
10042--------------------------
10043
10044The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10045depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10046settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10047written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10048described in this section.
10049
10050
100515.1. Bind options
10052-----------------
10053
10054The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10055as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10056no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10057parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10058while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10059provided immediately after the setting name.
10060
10061The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10062
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010063accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10064 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10065 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10066 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10067 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10068 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10069 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10070 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10071 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10072 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010073 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10074 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10075 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010077accept-proxy
10078 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010079 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10080 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010081 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10082 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10083 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10084 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10085 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10086 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10087 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010088 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10089 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010090
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010091alpn <protocols>
10092 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10093 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10094 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10095 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10096 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10097 initial NPN extension.
10098
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010099backlog <backlog>
10100 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10101 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10102
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010103curves <curves>
10104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10105 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10106 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10107 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10108 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10109 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10110
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010111ecdhe <named curve>
10112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010113 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10114 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010115
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010116ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10118 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10119 client's certificate.
10120
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010121ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10123 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10124 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10125 error is ignored.
10126
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010127ca-sign-file <cafile>
10128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10129 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10130 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10131 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10132 'generate-certificates' for details.
10133
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010134ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10136 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10137 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10138 'generate-certificates' for details.
10139
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010140ciphers <ciphers>
10141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10142 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010143 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010144 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10145 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10146
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010147crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10149 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10150 to verify client's certificate.
10151
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010152crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10154 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10155 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10156 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10157 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10158 file.
10159
10160 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10161 are loaded.
10162
10163 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010164 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010165 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10166 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10167 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10168 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10169 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10170 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10171 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010172
10173 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10174 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10175 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10176 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010177 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10178 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010179
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010180 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010181
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010182 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10183 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010184 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010185 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10186 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10187 clients).
10188
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010189 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10190 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10191 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10192 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10193 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10194 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10195 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10196 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10197 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10198 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10199 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10200 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10201 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10202
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010203 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10204 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10205 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10206 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10207 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10208
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010209 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10210 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10211 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10212 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010213
10214 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10215 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10216 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10217 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10218 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10219 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10220 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10221 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10222 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10223
10224 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10225
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010226 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010227 a cert bundle.
10228
10229 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10230 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10231 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10232 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10233 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10234 provide multi-cert support.
10235
10236 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10237
10238 Filename | CN | SAN
10239 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10240 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010241 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010242 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10243 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10244
10245 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10246 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10247 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10248 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010249 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10250 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010251
10252 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10253 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10254
10255 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10256 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10257 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10258
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010259crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10261 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010262 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010263 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010264
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010265crt-list <file>
10266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010267 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10268 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010269
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010270 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10271
10272 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010273 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010274 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010275
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010276 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10277 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10278 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10279 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10280 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10281 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10282 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10283 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010284
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010285 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010286 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010287 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10288 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10289 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010290
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010291 crt-list file example:
10292 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010293 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010294 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010295 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010297defer-accept
10298 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10299 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10300 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10301 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10302 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10303 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10304 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10305 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10306 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10307 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10308 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10309
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010310force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010311 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010312 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010313 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10314 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010315
10316force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010317 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010318 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10319 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010320
10321force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010322 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010323 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10324 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010325
10326force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010327 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010328 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10329 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010330
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010331generate-certificates
10332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10333 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10334 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10335 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10336 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10337 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10338 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10339 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10340 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10341 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10342 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10343
10344 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10345 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10346 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10347 certificate is used many times.
10348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010349gid <gid>
10350 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10351 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10352 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10353 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10354 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10355
10356group <group>
10357 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10358 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10359 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10360 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10361 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10362
10363id <id>
10364 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10365 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10366 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10367 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10368
10369interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010370 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10371 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10372 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10373 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10374 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10375 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10376 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010377
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010378level <level>
10379 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10380 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10381 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10382 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10383 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10384 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10385 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10386 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10387 counters).
10388 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10389 all counters).
10390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010391maxconn <maxconn>
10392 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10393 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10394 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10395 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10396 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10397 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10398 eat all memory.
10399
10400mode <mode>
10401 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10402 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10403 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10404 UNIX sockets.
10405
10406mss <maxseg>
10407 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10408 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10409 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10410 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10411 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10412 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10413 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10414 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10415 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10416 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10417 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10418
10419name <name>
10420 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10421 page.
10422
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010423namespace <name>
10424 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10425 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10426 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10427 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10428
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010429nice <nice>
10430 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10431 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10432 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10433 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10434 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10435 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10436 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10437 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10438 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10439 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10440 one for an RDP socket.
10441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010442no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010444 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010445 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010446 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10447 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010448 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010449
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010450no-tls-tickets
10451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10452 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10453 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010454 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10455 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010456
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010457no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010459 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010460 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010461 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10462 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10463 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010464
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010465no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010467 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010468 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010469 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10470 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10471 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010472
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010473no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010475 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010476 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010477 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10478 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10479 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010480
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010481npn <protocols>
10482 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10483 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10484 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10485 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010486 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10487 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010488
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010489process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10490 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10491 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10492 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10493 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10494 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10495 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10496 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010497 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10498 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10499 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10500 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10501 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10502 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10503 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010505ssl
10506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010507 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010508 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10509 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10510 to deciphered contents.
10511
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010512strict-sni
10513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10514 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10515 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10516 See the "crt" option for more information.
10517
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010518tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010519 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010520 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10521 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010522 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010523 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10524 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10525 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10526 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10527 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10528 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10529 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10530
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010531tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010532 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010533 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10534 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10535 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10536 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10537 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10538 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10539 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010540 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10541 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10542 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010543
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010544tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10545 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10546 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10547 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10548 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10549 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10550 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10551 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10552 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10553 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10554 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010556transparent
10557 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10558 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10559 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10560 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10561 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10562 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10563 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10564 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10565 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10566 so check for support with your vendor.
10567
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010568v4v6
10569 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10570 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10571 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10572 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010573 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010574
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010575v6only
10576 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10577 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10578 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010579 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10580 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010582uid <uid>
10583 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10584 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10585 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10586 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10587 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10588
10589user <user>
10590 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10591 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10592 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10593 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10594 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10595
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010596verify [none|optional|required]
10597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10598 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10599 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10600 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10601 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010602 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10603 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10604 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10605 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010606
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106075.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010608------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010610The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10611which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10612arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10613settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10614after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10615Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10616address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010618 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010619 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010621The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010622
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010623addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010624 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010625 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10626 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10627 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10628 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10629 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010631 Supported in default-server: No
10632
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010633agent-check
10634 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010635 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10636 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10637 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10638 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010639
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010640 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010641 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010642 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10643 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10644 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010645
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010646 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10647 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10648 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10649 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10650 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10651
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010652 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10653 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010654
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010655 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10656 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10657 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010658
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010659 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10660 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10661 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010662
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010663 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10664 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10665 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10666 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10667 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10668 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10669 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010670
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010671 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10672 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010673
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010674 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10675 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10676 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10677 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10678 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10679 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10680 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10681 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10682 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010683
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010684 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10685 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010686 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10687 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10688 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010689 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010690
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010691 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10692 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010693
10694 Supported in default-server: No
10695
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010696agent-send <string>
10697 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10698 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10699 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10700 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10701 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10702
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010703agent-inter <delay>
10704 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10705 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10706
10707 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10708 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10709 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10710 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10711 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10712 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10713 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10714 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10715 of backends use the same servers.
10716
10717 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10718
10719 Supported in default-server: Yes
10720
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010721agent-addr <addr>
10722 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10723
10724 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10725 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10726 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10727 hostname, it will be resolved.
10728
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010729agent-port <port>
10730 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10731
10732 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10733
10734 Supported in default-server: Yes
10735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010736backup
10737 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10738 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10739 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10740 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10741 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10742 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010744 Supported in default-server: No
10745
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010746ca-file <cafile>
10747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10748 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10749 server's certificate.
10750
10751 Supported in default-server: No
10752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010753check
10754 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010755 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10756 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10757 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10758 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10759 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10760 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10761 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010762 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10763 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10764 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010766 Supported in default-server: No
10767
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010768check-send-proxy
10769 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10770 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10771 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10772 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10773 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10774 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10775 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10776
10777 Supported in default-server: No
10778
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010779check-ssl
10780 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10781 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10782 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10783 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010784 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010785 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10786 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10787 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10788 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10789
10790 Supported in default-server: No
10791
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010792ciphers <ciphers>
10793 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010794 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010795 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10796 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10797 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10798 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10799 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10800 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10801
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010802 Supported in default-server: No
10803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010804cookie <value>
10805 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10806 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10807 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10808 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10809 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10810 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10811 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010813 Supported in default-server: No
10814
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010815crl-file <crlfile>
10816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10817 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10818 to verify server's certificate.
10819
10820 Supported in default-server: No
10821
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010822crt <cert>
10823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10824 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10825 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10826 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10827 certificate request.
10828
10829 Supported in default-server: No
10830
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010831disabled
10832 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10833 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10834 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10835 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10836 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10837
10838 Supported in default-server: No
10839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010840error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010841 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10842 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10843 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010845 Supported in default-server: Yes
10846
10847 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010849fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010850 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10851 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10852 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010854 Supported in default-server: Yes
10855
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010856force-sslv3
10857 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10858 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010859 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10860 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010861
10862 Supported in default-server: No
10863
10864force-tlsv10
10865 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010866 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10867 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010868
10869 Supported in default-server: No
10870
10871force-tlsv11
10872 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010873 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10874 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010875
10876 Supported in default-server: No
10877
10878force-tlsv12
10879 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010880 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10881 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010882
10883 Supported in default-server: No
10884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010885id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010886 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10887 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10888 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010890 Supported in default-server: No
10891
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010892init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10893 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10894 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10895 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10896 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10897 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10898 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10899 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10900 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10901 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10902 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10903 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10904 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10905 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10906 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10907 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10908 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10909 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10910 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10911 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10912 historic behaviour.
10913
10914 Example:
10915 defaults
10916 # never fail on address resolution
10917 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10918
10919 Supported in default-server: Yes
10920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010921inter <delay>
10922fastinter <delay>
10923downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010924 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10925 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10926 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10927 between checks depending on the server state :
10928
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010929 Server state | Interval used
10930 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10931 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10932 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10933 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10934 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10935 or yet unchecked. |
10936 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10937 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10938 | "inter" otherwise.
10939 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010941 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10942 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10943 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10944 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010945 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10946 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10947 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10948 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10949 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010951 Supported in default-server: Yes
10952
10953maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010954 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10955 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10956 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10957 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10958 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10959 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10960 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10961 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010963 Supported in default-server: Yes
10964
10965maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010966 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10967 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10968 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10969 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10970 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10971 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10972 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010974 Supported in default-server: Yes
10975
10976minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010977 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10978 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10979 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10980 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10981 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10982 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010983 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010984 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010986 Supported in default-server: Yes
10987
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010988namespace <name>
10989 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10990 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10991 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10992 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10993
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010994no-ssl-reuse
10995 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10996 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10997 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10998 and for paranoid users.
10999
11000 Supported in default-server: No
11001
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011002no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011003 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11004 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011005 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011006
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011007 Supported in default-server: No
11008
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011009no-tls-tickets
11010 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11011 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11012 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011013 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11014 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011015
11016 Supported in default-server: No
11017
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011018no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011019 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011020 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11021 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011022 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11023 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11024 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011025
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011026 Supported in default-server: No
11027
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011028no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011029 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011030 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11031 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011032 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11033 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11034 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011035
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011036 Supported in default-server: No
11037
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011038no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011039 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011040 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11041 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011042 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11043 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11044 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011045
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011046 Supported in default-server: No
11047
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011048non-stick
11049 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11050 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11051 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11052
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011053 Supported in default-server: No
11054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011055observe <mode>
11056 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11057 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11058 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11059 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11060 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11061 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011062 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011064 Supported in default-server: No
11065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011066 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011068on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011069 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11070 Currently, four modes are available:
11071 - fastinter: force fastinter
11072 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11073 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11074 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11075 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011077 Supported in default-server: Yes
11078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011079 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11080
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011081on-marked-down <action>
11082 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11083 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011084 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11085 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11086 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11087 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11088 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11089 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11090 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11091 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011092
11093 Actions are disabled by default
11094
11095 Supported in default-server: Yes
11096
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011097on-marked-up <action>
11098 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11099 Currently one action is available:
11100 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11101 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11102 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11103 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11104 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11105 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11106 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11107 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11108
11109 Actions are disabled by default
11110
11111 Supported in default-server: Yes
11112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011113port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011114 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11115 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11116 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11117 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11118 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11119 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011121 Supported in default-server: Yes
11122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011123redir <prefix>
11124 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11125 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11126 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11127 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11128 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11129 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11130 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11131 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011132 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011133 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11134 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11135 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11136 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11137 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11138
11139 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011141 Supported in default-server: No
11142
11143rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011144 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11145 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11146 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011148 Supported in default-server: Yes
11149
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011150resolve-prefer <family>
11151 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11152 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11153 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11154 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11155
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011156 Default value: ipv6
11157
11158 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011159
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011160 Example:
11161
11162 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011163
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011164resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11165 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11166 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011167 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011168 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11169 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11170 configured network, another address is selected.
11171
11172 Supported in default-server: Yes
11173
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011174 Example:
11175
11176 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011177
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011178resolvers <id>
11179 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11180 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011181 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11182 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11183 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11184 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011185
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011186 Supported in default-server: No
11187
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011188 Example:
11189
11190 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011191
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011192 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011193
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011194send-proxy
11195 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11196 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11197 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11198 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011199 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11200 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11201 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11202 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11203 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11204 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11205 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11206 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11207 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11208 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11209 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11210 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011211
11212 Supported in default-server: No
11213
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011214send-proxy-v2
11215 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11216 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11217 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11218 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11219 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11220 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11221 option of the "bind" keyword.
11222
11223 Supported in default-server: No
11224
11225send-proxy-v2-ssl
11226 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11227 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11228 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11229 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11230 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11231 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11232 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11233 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11234
11235 Supported in default-server: No
11236
11237send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11238 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11239 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11240 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11241 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11242 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11243 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11244 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11245 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11246 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11247
11248 Supported in default-server: No
11249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011250slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011251 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11252 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11253 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11254 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11255 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11256 parameters :
11257
11258 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11259 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11260
11261 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11262 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11263 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11264 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11265
11266 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11267 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11268 seen as failed.
11269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011270 Supported in default-server: Yes
11271
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011272sni <expression>
11273 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11274 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11275 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11276 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11277 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11278
11279 Supported in default-server: no
11280
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011281source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011282source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011283source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011284 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11285 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11286 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11287 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11288
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011289 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11290 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11291 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11292 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11293 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11294 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11295 server.
11296
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011297 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11298 specifying the source address without port(s).
11299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011300 Supported in default-server: No
11301
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011302ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011303 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11304 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11305 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11306 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11307 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11308 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011309 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011310
11311 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011312
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011313tcp-ut <delay>
11314 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11315 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11316 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011317 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011318 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11319 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11320 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11321 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11322 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11323 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11324 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11325 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11326 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011328track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011329 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11330 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11331 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11332 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011333 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011335 Supported in default-server: No
11336
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011337verify [none|required]
11338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011339 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11340 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11341 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11342 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011343 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11344 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11345 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011346
11347 Supported in default-server: No
11348
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011349verifyhost <hostname>
11350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11351 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11352 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11353 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11354 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11355 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11356
11357 Supported in default-server: No
11358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011359weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011360 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11361 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11362 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011363 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11364 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11365 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11366 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11367 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11368 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011370 Supported in default-server: Yes
11371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011372
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113735.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11374-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011375
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011376HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11377using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11378configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011379This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11380can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11381workload.
11382This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11383resolution at run time.
11384Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11385carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11386
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011387Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11388health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11389
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011390
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113915.3.1. Global overview
11392----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011393
11394As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11395different steps of the process life:
11396
11397 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11398 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11399 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11400
11401 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11402 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11403 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11404
11405A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11406 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11407 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11408 resolution to know this new IP.
11409
11410A few things important to notice:
11411 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11412 first valid response.
11413
11414 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11415 servers return an error.
11416
11417
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114185.3.2. The resolvers section
11419----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011420
11421This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11422HAProxy.
11423There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11424many name servers.
11425
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011426When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11427uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11428is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11429answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11430
11431When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11432used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11433
11434Two types of behavior can be applied:
11435 1. stop DNS resolution
11436 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11437 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11438 1. ANY query type
11439 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11440 server's parameter
11441 3. remaining family type
11442
11443HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11444 - invalid DNS response packet
11445 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11446 - NX domain
11447 - Query refused by server
11448 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11449
11450HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11451 - no Answer records in the response
11452 - DNS response truncated
11453 - Error in DNS response
11454 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11455 - name server timeout
11456
11457For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11458 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11459 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11460 applied;
11461 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11462 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11463 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11464 stops resolution.
11465
11466
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011467resolvers <resolvers id>
11468 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11469
11470A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11471
11472nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11473 DNS server description:
11474 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11475 <ip> : IP address of the server
11476 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11477
11478hold <status> <period>
11479 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11480 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011481 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11482 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011483 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11484 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11485 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11486
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011487 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011488
11489 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11490 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11491 the healch check.
11492
11493resolve_retries <nb>
11494 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11495 giving up.
11496 Default value: 3
11497
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011498 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11499 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11500 type.
11501
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011502timeout <event> <time>
11503 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11504 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11505 events available are:
11506 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11507 been received.
11508 Default value: 1s
11509 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11510 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11511
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011512 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011513
11514 resolvers mydns
11515 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11516 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11517 resolve_retries 3
11518 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011519 hold other 30s
11520 hold refused 30s
11521 hold nx 30s
11522 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011523 hold valid 10s
11524
11525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115266. HTTP header manipulation
11527---------------------------
11528
11529In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11530response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11531request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11532which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011533against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011535If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11536to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11537but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11538HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11539stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11540because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11541a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11542still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011544This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11545in section 4.2 :
11546
11547 - reqadd <string>
11548 - reqallow <search>
11549 - reqiallow <search>
11550 - reqdel <search>
11551 - reqidel <search>
11552 - reqdeny <search>
11553 - reqideny <search>
11554 - reqpass <search>
11555 - reqipass <search>
11556 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11557 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11558 - reqtarpit <search>
11559 - reqitarpit <search>
11560 - rspadd <string>
11561 - rspdel <search>
11562 - rspidel <search>
11563 - rspdeny <search>
11564 - rspideny <search>
11565 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11566 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11567
11568With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11569is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11570parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11571prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11572Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11573
11574 \t for a tab
11575 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11576 \n for a new line (LF)
11577 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11578 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11579 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11580 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11581 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11582
11583The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11584portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11585above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11586regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
115879 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11588is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11589
11590The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11591after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11592
11593Notes related to these keywords :
11594---------------------------------
11595 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11596 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11597 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11598
11599 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11600 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11601 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11602
11603 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11604 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11605 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11606 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11607 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11608
11609 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11610 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11611 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11612 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11613 useless headers before adding new ones.
11614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011615 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011616 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11617
11618 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11619 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11620 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11621
11622 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11623 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011624 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011625
11626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116277. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11628----------------------------------
11629
11630Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11631client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11632The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11633these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11634but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11635data called patterns.
11636
11637
116387.1. ACL basics
11639---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011640
11641The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11642content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11643from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11644simple :
11645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011647 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011648 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11649 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11652adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011653
11654In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011656 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011657
11658This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11659Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11660and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011661an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11662conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11663as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11664are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011665
11666ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11667'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11668which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11669
11670There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11671performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011673The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11674specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11675this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011676methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11677ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011678
11679Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11680 - boolean
11681 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11682 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11683 - string
11684 - data block
11685
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011686Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11687converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11688would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11689The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11690which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11691
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011692Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11693keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11694fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11695which are summarized in the table below :
11696
11697 +---------------------+-----------------+
11698 | Sample or converter | Default |
11699 | output type | matching method |
11700 +---------------------+-----------------+
11701 | boolean | bool |
11702 +---------------------+-----------------+
11703 | integer | int |
11704 +---------------------+-----------------+
11705 | ip | ip |
11706 +---------------------+-----------------+
11707 | string | str |
11708 +---------------------+-----------------+
11709 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11710 +---------------------+-----------------+
11711
11712Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11713matching method, see below.
11714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011715The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11716 - boolean
11717 - integer or integer range
11718 - IP address / network
11719 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11720 - regular expression
11721 - hex block
11722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011723The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11724
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011725 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11726 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011727 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011728 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011729 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011730 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011731 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011733The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11734read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11735if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11736lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11737will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11738beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11739a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11740lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11741exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11742
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011743The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11744parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11745ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11746a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11747check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11748
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011749The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11750socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11751file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011753Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11754loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11755
11756 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11757
11758In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11759the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11760case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11761as well.
11762
11763The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11764sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11765do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11766methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11767is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11768obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11769followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11770default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11771that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11772string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11773
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011774The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11775By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11776string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11777resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11778server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11779waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11780flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11781function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011783There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11784sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11785be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011786
11787 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11788 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011789 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11790 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11791 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11792 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011793
11794 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11795 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011796 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011797
11798 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011799 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011800
11801 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011802 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011803
11804 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11805 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11806
11807 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11808 binary or string samples.
11809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011810 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11811 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011813 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11814 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11815 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11818 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011820 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11821 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011823 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11824 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011826 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11827 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011828 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011830 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11831 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11832 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011833
11834For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11835request, it is possible to do :
11836
11837 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11838
11839In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11840buffer, one would use the following acl :
11841
11842 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11843
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011844On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11845possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11846
11847 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011849All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11850criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11851method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11852to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11853criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11854the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011857the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11858For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011860 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11861 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11862 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11863 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011864
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011865
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011866The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11867types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11868combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11869brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11870default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011872 +-------------------------------------------------+
11873 | Input sample type |
11874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011875 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11877 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011879 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011881 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011883 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011885 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011887 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011889 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011891 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011893 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011895 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011897 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011899 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11901 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011903
11904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119057.1.1. Matching booleans
11906------------------------
11907
11908In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11909Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11910When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11911that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11912
11913Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11914return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11915"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11916
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119187.1.2. Matching integers
11919------------------------
11920
11921Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11922enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11923to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11924
11925Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11926matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11927lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011928
11929For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11930unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11931representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11932
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011933As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11934two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11935instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11936ranges and operators.
11937
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011938For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011939operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11940Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11941of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011943Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011944
11945 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11946 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11947 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11948 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11949 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011951For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011952
11953 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11954
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011955This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11956
11957 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11958
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119607.1.3. Matching strings
11961-----------------------
11962
11963String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11964different forms :
11965
11966 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11967 patterns ;
11968
11969 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11970 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11971
11972 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11973 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11974
11975 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11976 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11977
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011978 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011979 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11980 matches.
11981
11982 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11983 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11984 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011985
11986String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11987exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11988characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11989string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11990to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011991before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011992
11993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119947.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11995---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011996
11997Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11998they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11999possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12000passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12001the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012002the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12003match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012004
12005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120067.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12007-------------------------------------
12008
12009It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12010not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12011a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12012to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12013digits may be used upper or lower case.
12014
12015Example :
12016 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12017 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12018
12019
120207.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12021---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012022
12023IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12024netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12025within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012026host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012027difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12028at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12029does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12030parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012031
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012032The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12033abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12034
12035 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12036 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12037 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12038 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12039 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12040 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12041 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12042 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12043
12044Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12045192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12046
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012047IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12048Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12049trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12050IPv6 patterns.
12051
12052HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12053following situations :
12054 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12055 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12056 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12057 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12058 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12059 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12060 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12061 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12062 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12063 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065
120667.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12067----------------------------------
12068
12069Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12070combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12071
12072 - AND (implicit)
12073 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12074 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012076A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012078 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012080Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12081indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12084"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12085requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12086is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12087
12088 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12089 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12090 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12091 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
12092
12093To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12094and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12095
12096 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12097 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12098 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12099 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12100
12101 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12102 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12103 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12104 use_backend www if host_www
12105
12106It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12107expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12108be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12109the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12110
12111 The following rule :
12112
12113 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12114 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12115
12116 Can also be written that way :
12117
12118 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12119
12120It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12121to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12122simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12123sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12124good use is the following :
12125
12126 With named ACLs :
12127
12128 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12129 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12130 monitor fail if site_dead
12131
12132 With anonymous ACLs :
12133
12134 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12135
12136See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12137
12138
121397.3. Fetching samples
12140---------------------
12141
12142Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12143against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12144sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12145ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12146of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12147available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12148
12149This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12150Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12151compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12152deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12153
12154The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12155matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12156method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12157indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12158
12159As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12160when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12161mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12162the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12163ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12164
12165Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12166multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12167when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12168incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12169are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12170is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12171all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12172
12173Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12174 - name
12175 - name(arg1)
12176 - name(arg1,arg2)
12177
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012178
121797.3.1. Converters
12180-----------------
12181
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012182Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12183of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12184is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12185was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12186has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12187unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12188
12189These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12190sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12191the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12192support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012193
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012194A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12195support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12196supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12197(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12198bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012200The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012201
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001220251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12203 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12204 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12205 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12206 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12207 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12208
12209 Example :
12210 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12211 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12212 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12213 frontend http-in
12214 bind *:8081
12215 default_backend servers
12216 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12217 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12218
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012219add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012220 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012221 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012222 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12223 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012224 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012225 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12226 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12228 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012230 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012231
12232and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012233 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012234 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012235 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12236 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012237 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012238 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12239 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12240 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12241 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12242 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012243 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012244
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012245base64
12246 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12247 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12248 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12249
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012250bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012251 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012252 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12253 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12254 presence of a flag).
12255
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012256bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12257 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12258 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012259 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012260
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012261cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012262 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12263 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012264
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012265crc32([<avalanche>])
12266 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12267 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12268 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12269 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12270 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12271 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12272 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12273 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12274 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12275 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12276 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12277
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012278da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012279 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12280 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12281 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12282 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012283 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012284 configuration language.
12285
12286 Example:
12287 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012288 bind *:8881
12289 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012290 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012291
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012292debug
12293 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12294 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12295 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12296
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012297div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012298 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12299 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012300 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012301 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12302 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12307 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12308 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012309 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012310
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012311djb2([<avalanche>])
12312 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12313 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12314 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12315 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12316 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12317 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12318 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012319 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12320 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012321
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012322even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012323 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012324 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12325
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012326field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12327 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12328 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12329 list of chars.
12330
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012331hex
12332 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12333 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12334 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12335 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012336
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012337http_date([<offset>])
12338 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12339 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12340 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12341 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12342 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12343 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012344
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012345in_table(<table>)
12346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12348 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12349 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12350 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12351
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012352ipmask(<mask>)
12353 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12354 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12355 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12356 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12357
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012358json([<input-code>])
12359 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12360 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012361 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012362 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12363 of errors:
12364 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12365 bytes, ...)
12366 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12367 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12368
12369 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12370 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12371 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12372 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12373 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12374 are :
12375 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12376 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12377 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12378 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12379 error ;
12380 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12381 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12382
12383 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12384 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12385
12386 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012387 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012388 capture request header user-agent len 150
12389 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012390
12391 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12392 GET / HTTP/1.0
12393 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12394
12395 Output log:
12396 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12397
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012398language(<value>[,<default>])
12399 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12400 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12401 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12402 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12403 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12404 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12405 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12406 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12407 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12408 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12409 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12410 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012412 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012413
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012414 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12415 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012417 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12418 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12419 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12420 use_backend spanish if es
12421 use_backend french if fr
12422 use_backend english if en
12423 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012424
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012425lower
12426 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12427 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12428 type. The result is of type string.
12429
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012430ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12431 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12432 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12433 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12434 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12435 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12436 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12437
12438 Example :
12439
12440 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12441 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12442 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12443
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012444map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12445map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12446map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12447 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12448 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12449 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12450 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12451 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12452 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12453 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12454 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012456 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12457 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12458 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012459
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012460 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012461 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012462
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012463 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12464 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12465 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12466 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012467 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12468 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012469 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12470 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12471 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12472 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12473 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12474 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12475 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12476 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012477 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12478 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12479 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012480 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12481 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12482 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12483 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12484 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012485
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012486 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12487 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12488 the corresponding match text.
12489
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012490 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12491 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12492 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12493 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12494 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012495
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012496 Example :
12497
12498 # this is a comment and is ignored
12499 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12500 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12501 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12502 | | | `---------- value
12503 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12504 | `---------------------------- key
12505 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12506
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012507mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012508 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12509 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012510 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012511 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012512 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012513 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12514 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12515 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12516 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12517 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012518 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012519
12520mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012521 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012522 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12523 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012524 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012525 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012526 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012527 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12528 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12529 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12530 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12531 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012532 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012533
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012534nbsrv
12535 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12536 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12537 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12538 map lookup.
12539
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012540neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012541 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12542 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12543 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12544 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012545
12546not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012547 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012548 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12549 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12550 absence of a flag).
12551
12552odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012553 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012554 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12555
12556or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012557 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012558 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012559 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12560 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012561 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012562 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12563 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12564 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12565 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12566 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012567 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012568
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012569regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012570 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12571 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12572 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12573 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12574 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12575 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12576 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12577 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12578 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12579 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012580 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12581 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12582 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12583 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012584
12585 Example :
12586
12587 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12588 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12589 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12590 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12591
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012592capture-req(<id>)
12593 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12594 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12595
12596 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012597 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12598 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012599
12600capture-res(<id>)
12601 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12602 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12603
12604 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012605 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12606 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012607
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012608sdbm([<avalanche>])
12609 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12610 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12611 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12612 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12613 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12614 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12615 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012616 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12617 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012618
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012619set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012620 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12621 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12622 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012623 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012624 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12625 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012626 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012627 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12628 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012630 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012631
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012632sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012633 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12634 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012635 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012636 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12637 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012641 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012646
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012647table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12650 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12651 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12652 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12653 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12654
12655
12656table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12657 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12658 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12659 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12660 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12661 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12662 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12663
12664table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12665 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12666 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12667 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12668 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12669 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12670
12671table_conn_cur(<table>)
12672 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12673 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12674 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12675 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12676 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12677
12678table_conn_rate(<table>)
12679 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12680 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12681 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12682 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12683 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12684
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012685table_gpt0(<table>)
12686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12689 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12690 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12691
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012692table_gpc0(<table>)
12693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12696 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12697 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12698
12699table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12700 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12701 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12702 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12703 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12704 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12705 sample fetch keyword.
12706
12707table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12708 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12709 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12710 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12711 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12712 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12713
12714table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12715 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12716 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12717 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12718 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12719 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12720 keyword.
12721
12722table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12723 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12724 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12725 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12726 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12727 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12728
12729table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12730 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12731 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12732 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12733 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12734 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12735 keyword.
12736
12737table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12738 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12739 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12740 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12741 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12742 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12743 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12744 keyword.
12745
12746table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12747 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12748 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12749 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12750 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12751 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12752 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12753 keyword.
12754
12755table_server_id(<table>)
12756 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12757 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12758 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12759 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12760 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12761 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12762
12763table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12767 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12768 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12769 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12770 keyword.
12771
12772table_sess_rate(<table>)
12773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12776 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12777 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12778 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12779 keyword.
12780
12781table_trackers(<table>)
12782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12785 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12786 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12787 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12788 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12789 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12790 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12791 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12792
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012793upper
12794 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12795 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12796 type. The result is of type string.
12797
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012798url_dec
12799 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12800 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12801
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012802unset-var(<var name>)
12803 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12804 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12805 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12806 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12807 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12808 response),
12809 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12810 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12811 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12812 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12813
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012814utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12815 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12816 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12817 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12818 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12819 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12820 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12821
12822 Example :
12823
12824 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12825 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12826 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12827
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012828word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12829 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12830 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12831
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012832wt6([<avalanche>])
12833 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12834 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12835 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12836 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12837 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12838 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12839 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012840 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12841 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012842
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012843xor(<value>)
12844 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012845 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012846 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012847 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012848 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012849 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12850 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012851 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012852 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12853 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012854 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012855 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012856
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012857xxh32([<seed>])
12858 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12859 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12860 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12861 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12862 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12863 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12864 as cryptographically secure.
12865
12866xxh64([<seed>])
12867 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12868 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12869 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12870 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12871 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12872 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12873 as cryptographically secure.
12874
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128767.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877--------------------------------------------
12878
12879A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12880not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12881"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12882The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12883
12884always_false : boolean
12885 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12886 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12887
12888always_true : boolean
12889 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12890 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12891
12892avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012893 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12895 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12896 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12897 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12898 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12899 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12900 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12901 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12902 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12903 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12904 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12905 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12906 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012909 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12910 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12911 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12912 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12913 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12917 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12918 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12919 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12920 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12921 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012922
12923 Example :
12924 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12925 backend dynamic
12926 mode http
12927 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12928 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012929
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012930bin(<hexa>) : bin
12931 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12932 of the string.
12933
12934bool(<bool>) : bool
12935 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12936 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012938connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12939 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012940 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012941 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12942 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012943
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012944 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012945 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012946 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12947
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012948 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12949 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012950
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012951 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012952 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012954 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12955 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012957 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012958
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012959 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12960 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012961 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012962 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012963
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012964date([<offset>]) : integer
12965 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12966 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12967 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12968 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012969 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12970
12971 Example :
12972
12973 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12974 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012975
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012976env(<name>) : string
12977 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12978 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12979 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12980 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12981 certain way.
12982
12983 Examples :
12984 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12985 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12986
12987 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12988 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12991 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012992 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12993 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12995 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12996 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12997 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12998 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012999
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013000fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13001 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13002 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13003 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013005fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13007 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13008 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13009 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13010 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13011 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13012 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13013 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013014
13015 Example :
13016 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13017 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13018 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13019 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13020 frontend mail
13021 bind :25
13022 mode tcp
13023 maxconn 100
13024 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13025 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13026 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13027 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013028
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013029hostname : string
13030 Returns the system hostname.
13031
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013032int(<integer>) : signed integer
13033 Returns a signed integer.
13034
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013035ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13036 Returns an ipv4.
13037
13038ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13039 Returns an ipv6.
13040
13041meth(<method>) : method
13042 Returns a method.
13043
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013044nbproc : integer
13045 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13046 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13047 and debugging purposes.
13048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013049nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13051 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13052 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013053 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13054 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13055 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013056
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013057proc : integer
13058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13059 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13060 debugging purposes.
13061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013063 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13064 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13065 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13067 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13068 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13069 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13070 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13071
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013072rand([<range>]) : integer
13073 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13074 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13075 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13076 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13077 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13081 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13082 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13083 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13084 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13085 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13086 methods.
13087
13088srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13089 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13090 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13091 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13092 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13093 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13094 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13095 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13096
13097srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13098 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13099 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013100 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13102 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13103 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13104 overloading servers).
13105
13106 Example :
13107 # Redirect to a separate back
13108 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13109 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13110 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13111
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013112stopping : boolean
13113 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13114 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13115 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13116
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013117str(<string>) : string
13118 Returns a string.
13119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013120table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13121 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13122 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13123
13124table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13125 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13126 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13127 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13128
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013129var(<var-name>) : undefined
13130 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013131 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13132 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013133 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013134 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13135 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013136 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013137 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13138 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013139 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013140 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131427.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013143----------------------------------
13144
13145The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13146closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13147methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13148sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13149TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013150the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13151counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13152"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013153argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13154the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13155this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156
13157be_id : integer
13158 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13159 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13160
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013161be_name : string
13162 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13163 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165dst : ip
13166 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13167 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13168 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13169 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13170 RFC 4291.
13171
13172dst_conn : integer
13173 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13174 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13175 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13176 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13177 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13178 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13179 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13180 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013181
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013182dst_is_local : boolean
13183 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13184 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13185 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13186 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13187 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13188 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13189 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13190 it only once per connection.
13191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013192dst_port : integer
13193 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13194 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13195 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13196 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13197 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13198 an HTTP header.
13199
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013200fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13201 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13202 header.
13203
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013204fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13205 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13206 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13207 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13208 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13209 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13210 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13211
13212fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13213 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13214 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13215 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13216 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13217 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13218 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13219
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013220fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13221 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13222 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13223 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13224 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13225
13226fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13227 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13228 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13229 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13230 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13231
13232fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13233 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13234 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13235 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13236 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13237
13238fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13239 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13240 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13241 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13242 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13243
13244fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13245 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13246 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13247 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13248 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13249
13250fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13251 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13252 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13253 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13254 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013256fe_id : integer
13257 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013258 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013259 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13260
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013261fe_name : string
13262 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13263 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13264 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13265
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013266sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013267sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13268sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13269sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013270 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13271 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13272 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13273
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013274sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013275sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13276sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13277sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013278 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13279 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13280 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13281
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013282sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013283sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13284sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13285sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013286 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13287 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013288 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13289 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13290 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013291
13292 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13293 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013294 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13295 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13296 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013297 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13298 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13299
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013300sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013301sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13302sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13303sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013304 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13305 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13306
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013307sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013308sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13309sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13310sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013311 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13312 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13313 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13314
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013315sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013316sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13317sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13318sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013319 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13320 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13321 See also src_conn_rate.
13322
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013323sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013324sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13325sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13326sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013327 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013328 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013329
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013330sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13331sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13332sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13333sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13334 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13335 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013337sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013338sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13339sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13340sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013341 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13342 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13343 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013344 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13345 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13346 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013347
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013348sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013349sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13350sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13351sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013352 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13353 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13354 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13355
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013356sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013357sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13358sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13359sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013360 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13361 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13362 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13363 src_http_err_rate.
13364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013365sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013366sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13367sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13368sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013369 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13370 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13371 src_http_req_cnt.
13372
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013373sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013374sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13375sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13376sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013377 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13378 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13379 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13380 src_http_req_rate.
13381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013382sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013383sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13384sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13385sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013386 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013387 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13388 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13389 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13390 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013391
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013392 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13393 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013394 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013396sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013397sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13398sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13399sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013400 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13401 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13402 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013403
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013404sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013405sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13406sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13407sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013408 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13409 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13410 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013412sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013413sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13414sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13415sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013416 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13417 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13418 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13419 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013420 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013421 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13422
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013423sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013424sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13425sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13426sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013427 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13428 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13429 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13430 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13431 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013432 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013433
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013434sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013435sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13436sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13437sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013438 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13439 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13440 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13441
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013442sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013443sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13444sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13445sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013446 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13447 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013448 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013449 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13450 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13452 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13453 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455so_id : integer
13456 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13457 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13458 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460src : ip
13461 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13462 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13463 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13464 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013465 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13466 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13467 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13468 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013469
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013470 Example:
13471 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13472 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13475 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13476 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13477 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013478 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013480src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13481 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13482 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013483 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013484 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13487 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13488 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13489 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13490 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13491 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13492 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013493
13494 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13495 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13496 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13497 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013498 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013499 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13500 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013502src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013503 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013504 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013505 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013506 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013508src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013509 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013510 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13511 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013512 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013514src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13515 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13516 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13517 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013518 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013521 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013522 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013523 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013524 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013525
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013526src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13527 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13528 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13529 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13530 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013532src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013533 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013535 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13536 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013537 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13538 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13539 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13542 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13543 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013544 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013545 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13549 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13550 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13551 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13552 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013553 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13556 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13557 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13558 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013559 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13562 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13563 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13564 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013565 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013566 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013568src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13569 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13570 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13571 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013572 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013573 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13574 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013575
13576 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013577 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013578 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013579
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013580src_is_local : boolean
13581 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13582 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13583 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13584 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13585 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13586 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13587 once per connection.
13588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013590 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13591 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13592 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13593 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13594 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013596src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013597 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13598 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13599 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13600 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13601 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603src_port : integer
13604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13605 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13606 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13607 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013609src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13610 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013611 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13612 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13613 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013614 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13617 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13618 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13619 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13620 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013621 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13624 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13625 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13626 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13627 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13628 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13629 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13630 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13631 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013632
13633 Example :
13634 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13635 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13636 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13637 listen ssh
13638 bind :22
13639 mode tcp
13640 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013641 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013642 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013643 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645srv_id : integer
13646 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13647 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13648 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136507.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013653The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13654closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13655when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13656usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013657future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013658
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001365951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13660 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13661 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13662 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13663 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13664 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13665
13666 Example :
13667 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13668 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13669 # the request.
13670 frontend http-in
13671 bind *:8081
13672 default_backend servers
13673 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13674 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13675
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013676ssl_bc : boolean
13677 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13678 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13679 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13680
13681ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13682 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13683 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13684
13685ssl_bc_cipher : string
13686 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13687 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13688
13689ssl_bc_protocol : string
13690 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13691 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13692
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013693ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013694 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013695 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13696 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013697
13698ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13699 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13700 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13701 if session was reused or not.
13702
13703ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13704 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13705 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013707ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13708 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13709 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13710 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13711 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13712 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13715 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13716 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13717 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13718 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013719
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013720ssl_c_der : binary
13721 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13722 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13723 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725ssl_c_err : integer
13726 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13727 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13728 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13729 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13730 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013732ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13733 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13734 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13735 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13736 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13737 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13738 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13739 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13740 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742ssl_c_key_alg : string
13743 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13744 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13745 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747ssl_c_notafter : string
13748 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13749 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13750 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752ssl_c_notbefore : string
13753 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13754 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13755 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013757ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13758 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13759 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13760 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13761 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13762 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13763 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13764 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13765 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767ssl_c_serial : binary
13768 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13769 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13770 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13773 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13774 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13775 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013776 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13777 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13778
13779 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13782 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13783 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13784 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013786ssl_c_used : boolean
13787 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13788 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790ssl_c_verify : integer
13791 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13792 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13793 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13794 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013796ssl_c_version : integer
13797 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13798 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013799
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013800ssl_f_der : binary
13801 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13802 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13803 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013805ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13807 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13808 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13812 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13813 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013815ssl_f_key_alg : string
13816 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13817 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13818 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820ssl_f_notafter : string
13821 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13822 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13823 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013825ssl_f_notbefore : string
13826 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13827 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13828 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13832 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13833 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13834 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13835 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13836 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13837 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13838 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013840ssl_f_serial : binary
13841 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13842 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13843 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013844
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013845ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13846 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13847 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13848 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13851 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13852 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13853 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013855ssl_f_version : integer
13856 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13857 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13858
13859ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013860 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13861 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13862 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864 Example :
13865 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13866 listen http-https
13867 bind :80
13868 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13869 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13870
13871ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13872 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13873 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13874
13875ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013876 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13878 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13879 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13880 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13881 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13882 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13883 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13884 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886ssl_fc_cipher : string
13887 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13888 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013889
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013890ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
13891 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
13892 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013893 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013894
13895ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
13896 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
13897 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013898 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013899
13900ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
13901 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
13902 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
13903 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
13904 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
13905 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
13906 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
13907
13908ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
13909 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
13910 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013911 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013913ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013914 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13915 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013916 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13917 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13918 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13919 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13922 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013923 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13924 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13925 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13926 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013927
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013928ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013929 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13930 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013933 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13935 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13936 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13937 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13938 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13939 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13940 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013942ssl_fc_protocol : string
13943 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13944 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013945
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013946ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013947 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013948 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13949 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13952 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13953 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13954 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13955 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957ssl_fc_sni : string
13958 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13959 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13960 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13961 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13962 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13963
13964 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13965 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13966 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013967 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13968 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013971 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13972 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13975 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13976 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013977
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013978
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139797.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013982Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13983sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13984only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13985For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13986be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13987can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13988sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13989for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13990content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013992payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13993 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13994 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13995 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013997payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13998 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13999 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14000 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002req.len : integer
14003req_len : integer (deprecated)
14004 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14005 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14006 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14007 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14008 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14009 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14010 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14011 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014013req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14014 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014015 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14016 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14017 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14018 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014020 ACL alternatives :
14021 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14024 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14025 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14026 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14027 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014029 ACL alternatives :
14030 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014032 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034req.proto_http : boolean
14035req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14036 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14037 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14038 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14039 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14040 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14041 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14042 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014044 Example:
14045 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14046 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14047 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014048 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014050req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14051rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14052 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14053 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14054 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14055 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14056 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14057 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14058 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014060 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14061 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14062 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14063 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14064 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14065 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014067 ACL derivatives :
14068 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070 Example :
14071 listen tse-farm
14072 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14073 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14074 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14075 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14076 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14077 persist rdp-cookie
14078 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14079 # This is only useful makes sense if
14080 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14081 stick-table type string size 204800
14082 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14083 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14084 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14087 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14090rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14091 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14092 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14093 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14094 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014096 ACL derivatives :
14097 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014098
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014099req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14100 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14101 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014102 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14103 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14104 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14105 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14106 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14109req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14110 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14111 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14112 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14113 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14114 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14115 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14116 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118req.ssl_sni : string
14119req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14120 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14121 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14122 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14123 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14124 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14125 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14126 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14127 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14128 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14129 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14130 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14131 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133 ACL derivatives :
14134 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136 Examples :
14137 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14138 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14139 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14140 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14141 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014142
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014143req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14144 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14145 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14146 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14147 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14148 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14149 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14150 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14151 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14152 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014154req.ssl_ver : integer
14155req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14156 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14157 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14158 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14159 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14160 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14161 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14162 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14163 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14164 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166 ACL derivatives :
14167 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014168
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014169res.len : integer
14170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14171 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14172 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14173 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14174 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14175 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14176 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14177 content inspection.
14178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14180 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014181 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14182 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14183 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14184 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14187 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14188 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14189 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14190 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014192 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014193
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014194res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14195rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14196 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14197 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14198 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14199 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14200 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14201 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14202 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204wait_end : boolean
14205 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14206 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14207 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14208 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14209 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14210 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14211 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14212 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214 Examples :
14215 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14216 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14217 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14220 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14221 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14222 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14223 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14224 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14225 tcp-request content reject
14226
14227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142287.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229--------------------------------------
14230
14231It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14232This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14233data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14234its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14235HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14236content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14237to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14238more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14239response are indexed.
14240
14241base : string
14242 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14243 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14244 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14245 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14246 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14247 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14248 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14249 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14250
14251 ACL derivatives :
14252 base : exact string match
14253 base_beg : prefix match
14254 base_dir : subdir match
14255 base_dom : domain match
14256 base_end : suffix match
14257 base_len : length match
14258 base_reg : regex match
14259 base_sub : substring match
14260
14261base32 : integer
14262 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14263 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14264 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014265 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14266 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14267 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268
14269base32+src : binary
14270 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14271 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14272 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14273 per-URL counters.
14274
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014275capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14276 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14277 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14278 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14279
14280capture.req.method : string
14281 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14282 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14283 because it's allocated.
14284
14285capture.req.uri : string
14286 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14287 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14288 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14289 allocated.
14290
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014291capture.req.ver : string
14292 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14293 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14294 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14295
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014296capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14297 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14298 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14299 The first entry is an index of 0.
14300 See also: "capture response header"
14301
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014302capture.res.ver : string
14303 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14304 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14305 persistent flag.
14306
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014307req.body : binary
14308 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14309 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14310 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14311 the first chunk is analyzed.
14312
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014313req.body_param([<name>) : string
14314 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14315 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14316 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14317 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14318 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14319 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14320 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14321 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14322 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14323 given.
14324
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014325req.body_len : integer
14326 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14327 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14328 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14329 "option http-buffer-request".
14330
14331req.body_size : integer
14332 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14333 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14334 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14335 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14336 "option http-buffer-request".
14337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338req.cook([<name>]) : string
14339cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14340 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14341 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14342 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14343 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14344 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14345 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14346 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14347 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14348
14349 ACL derivatives :
14350 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14351 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14352 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14353 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14354 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14355 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14356 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14357 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14360cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14361 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14362 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014364req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14365cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14366 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14367 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14368 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14369 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14372 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14373 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14374 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14375 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014376 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14378 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14379 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14380 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14383 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14384 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14385 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14386 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014387 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14390 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14391 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14392 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14393 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14394 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14395 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14396 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14397 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014399req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14400 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14401 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14402 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14403 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014405req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14406 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14407 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14408 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14409 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14410 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14411 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14412 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14413 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14414 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14415 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14416 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418 ACL derivatives :
14419 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14420 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14421 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14422 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14423 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14424 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14425 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14426 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14427
14428req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14429hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14430 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14431 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14432 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14433 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14434 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14435 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14436 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14437 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14438 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14439
14440req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14441hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14442 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14443 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14444 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14445 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14446 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14447 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14448 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14449 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14450
14451req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14452hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14453 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14454 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14455 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14456 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14457 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14458 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14459 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14460
14461http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14462 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14463 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14464 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14465 basic auth is supported.
14466
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014467http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14468 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14469 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14470 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14471 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014472 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14473 basic auth is supported.
14474
14475 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014476 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14477 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14478 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14479 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480
14481http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014482 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14483 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014484 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14485 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014487method : integer + string
14488 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14489 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14490 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14491 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14492 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14493 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14494 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 ACL derivatives :
14497 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499 Example :
14500 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14501 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14502 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504path : string
14505 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14506 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14507 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14508 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14509 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14510 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14511 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513 ACL derivatives :
14514 path : exact string match
14515 path_beg : prefix match
14516 path_dir : subdir match
14517 path_dom : domain match
14518 path_end : suffix match
14519 path_len : length match
14520 path_reg : regex match
14521 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014522
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014523query : string
14524 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14525 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14526 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14527 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014528 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014529 which stops before the question mark.
14530
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014531req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14532 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14533 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14534 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14535 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537req.ver : string
14538req_ver : string (deprecated)
14539 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14540 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14541 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543 ACL derivatives :
14544 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546res.comp : boolean
14547 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14548 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14549 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551res.comp_algo : string
14552 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14553 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14554 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556res.cook([<name>]) : string
14557scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14558 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14559 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14560 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562 ACL derivatives :
14563 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014565res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14566scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14567 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14568 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14569 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14572scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14573 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14574 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14575 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14578 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14579 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14580 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14581 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14582 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14583 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14584 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14585 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14586 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014588res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14589 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14590 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14591 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14592 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14593 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14596shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14597 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14598 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14599 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14600 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14601 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14602 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14603 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14604 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606 ACL derivatives :
14607 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14608 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14609 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14610 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14611 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14612 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14613 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14614 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14615
14616res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14617shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14618 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14619 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14620 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14621 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14622 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014624res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14625shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14626 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14627 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14628 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14629 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14630 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14631 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014632
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014633res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14634 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14635 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14636 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14637 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14640shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14641 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14642 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14643 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14644 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14645 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14646 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648res.ver : string
14649resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14650 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14651 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653 ACL derivatives :
14654 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14657 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14658 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014659 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14663 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014665status : integer
14666 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14667 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14668 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014669
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014670unique-id : string
14671 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14672 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14673 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14674 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14675 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14676 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678url : string
14679 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14680 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14681 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14682 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14683 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14684 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14685 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014687 ACL derivatives :
14688 url : exact string match
14689 url_beg : prefix match
14690 url_dir : subdir match
14691 url_dom : domain match
14692 url_end : suffix match
14693 url_len : length match
14694 url_reg : regex match
14695 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014697url_ip : ip
14698 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14699 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14700 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14701 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14702 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14703 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14704 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014706url_port : integer
14707 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14708 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14709 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14710 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014711
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014712urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14713url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14715 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014716 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14717 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14718 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14719 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14721 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014722 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14723 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725 ACL derivatives :
14726 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14727 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14728 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14729 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14730 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14731 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14732 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14733 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014734
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014736 Example :
14737 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14738 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14739 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14740 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014741
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014742urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14744 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14745 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014746
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014747url32 : integer
14748 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14749 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14750 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14751 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14752 is an unsigned integer.
14753
14754url32+src : binary
14755 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14756 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14757 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14758
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147607.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014761---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014763Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14764every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014765order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014767ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14768---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014769FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014770HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014771HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14772HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014773HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14774HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14775HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14776HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14777LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014778METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014779METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014780METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14781METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14782METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14783METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014784METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014785METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014786RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014787REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014788TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014789WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14790---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014791
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147938. Logging
14794----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014795
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014796One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14797provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14798very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14799provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14800state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014801to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014802headers.
14803
14804In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14805about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14806send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14807
14808 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14809 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14810 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14811 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14812 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014813 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14814 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014815
14816The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14817allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14818as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14819while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14820real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14821delay.
14822
14823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148248.1. Log levels
14825---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014826
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014827TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014828source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014829HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14830in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14831track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14832syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14833about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014834
14835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148368.2. Log formats
14837----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014838
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014839HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014840and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14841slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14842options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014843
14844 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14845 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14846 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14847 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14848 extents.
14849
14850 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14851 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14852 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14853 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14854 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14855
14856 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14857 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14858 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14859 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14860 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14861
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014862 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14863 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14864 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14865 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14866
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014867 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14868
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014869Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14870specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14871field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14872servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14873always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14874identifier.
14875
14876Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14877 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14878 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14879 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14880 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14881
14882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148838.2.1. Default log format
14884-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014885
14886This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14887as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14888format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14889
14890 Example :
14891 listen www
14892 mode http
14893 log global
14894 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14895
14896 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14897 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14898 (www/HTTP)
14899
14900 Field Format Extract from the example above
14901 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14902 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14903 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14904 4 'to' to
14905 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14906 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14907
14908Detailed fields description :
14909 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14910 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14911 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14912 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14913 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14914 and processed the connection.
14915 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14916
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014917In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14918"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14919connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014921It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14922will eventually disappear.
14923
14924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149258.2.2. TCP log format
14926---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014927
14928The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14929is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14930information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14931counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14932emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14933environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14934the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14935sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014936specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14937not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14938fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14939marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014940
14941 Example :
14942 frontend fnt
14943 mode tcp
14944 option tcplog
14945 log global
14946 default_backend bck
14947
14948 backend bck
14949 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14950
14951 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14952 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14953 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14954
14955 Field Format Extract from the example above
14956 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14957 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14958 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14959 4 frontend_name fnt
14960 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14961 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14962 7 bytes_read* 212
14963 8 termination_state --
14964 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14965 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14966
14967Detailed fields description :
14968 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014969 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14970 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14971 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014972 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14973 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14974 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014975
14976 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014977 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14978 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14979 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014980
14981 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14982 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14983 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14984 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14985
14986 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14987 and processed the connection.
14988
14989 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14990 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14991 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14992 applications.
14993
14994 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14995 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14996 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14997 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14998 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14999
15000 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15001 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15002 See "Timers" below for more details.
15003
15004 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15005 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15006 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15007 "Timers" below for more details.
15008
15009 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015010 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015011 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15012 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15013 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15014 details.
15015
15016 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15017 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15018 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15019 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15020 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15021
15022 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15023 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15024 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15025 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15026 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15027 for more details.
15028
15029 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015030 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015031 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15032 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15033 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015034 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015035
15036 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15037 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15038 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15039 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15040 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15041 caused by a denial of service attack.
15042
15043 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15044 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15045 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15046 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15047 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15048 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15049 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15050 denial of service attack.
15051
15052 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15053 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15054 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15055 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15056 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15057 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15058 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15059 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15060 be processed than on other servers.
15061
15062 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15063 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15064 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15065 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15066 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15067 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15068 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15069 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15070 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15071 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15072 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15073 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15074 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15075
15076 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15077 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15078 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15079 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15080 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15081 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15082 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15083 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15084
15085 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15086 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15087 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15088 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15089 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15090 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15091 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15092 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15093 occurs.
15094
15095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150968.2.3. HTTP log format
15097----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015098
15099The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15100is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15101the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15102are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15103emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15104generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15105"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15106which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015107frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15108is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015109
15110Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15111slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15112with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15113
15114 Example :
15115 frontend http-in
15116 mode http
15117 option httplog
15118 log global
15119 default_backend bck
15120
15121 backend static
15122 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15123
15124 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15125 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15126 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015127 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015128
15129 Field Format Extract from the example above
15130 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15131 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015132 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015133 4 frontend_name http-in
15134 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015135 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015136 7 status_code 200
15137 8 bytes_read* 2750
15138 9 captured_request_cookie -
15139 10 captured_response_cookie -
15140 11 termination_state ----
15141 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15142 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15143 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15144 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15145 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015146
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015147Detailed fields description :
15148 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015149 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15150 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15151 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015152 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15153 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15154 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015155
15156 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015157 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15158 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15159 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015160
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015161 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15162 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015163
15164 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15165 and processed the connection.
15166
15167 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15168 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15169 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15170
15171 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15172 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15173 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15174 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15175 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15176 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015178 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15179 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15180 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15181 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15182 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15183 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15184 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015185
15186 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15187 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15188 See "Timers" below for more details.
15189
15190 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15191 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15192 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15193 below for more details.
15194
15195 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15196 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15197 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15198 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15199 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15200 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15201 for more details.
15202
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015203 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15204 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15205 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15206 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15207 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15208 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15209 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15210 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015211
15212 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15213 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15214 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15215
15216 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15217 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15218 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15219 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15220 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15221 overflowing.
15222
15223 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15224 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15225 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15226 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15227 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15228 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15229 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15230 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15231
15232 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15233 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15234 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15235 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15236 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15237 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15238 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15239 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15240
15241 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15242 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15243 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15244 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15245 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15246 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15247 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15248
15249 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015250 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015251 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15252 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15253 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015254 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015255 system.
15256
15257 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15258 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15259 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15260 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15261 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15262 caused by a denial of service attack.
15263
15264 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15265 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15266 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15267 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15268 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15269 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15270 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15271 denial of service attack.
15272
15273 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15274 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15275 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15276 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15277 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15278 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15279 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15280 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15281 processed than on other servers.
15282
15283 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15284 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15285 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15286 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15287 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15288 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15289 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15290 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15291 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15292 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15293 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15294 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15295 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15296
15297 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15298 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15299 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15300 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15301 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15302 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15303 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15304 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15305
15306 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15307 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15308 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15309 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15310 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15311 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15312 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15313 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15314 occurs.
15315
15316 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15317 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15318 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15319 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15320 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15321 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15322 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15323 cookies" below for more details.
15324
15325 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15326 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15327 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15328 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15329 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15330 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15331 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15332 and cookies" below for more details.
15333
15334 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15335 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15336 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15337 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15338 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15339 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15340 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15341 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15342
15343
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200153448.2.4. Custom log format
15345------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015346
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015347The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015348mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015349
15350HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15351Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15352separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15353prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15354
15355Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15356variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015357("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015358
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015359If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015360as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015361less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15362the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15363
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015364Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015365In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015366in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015367
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015368Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15369'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15370https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15371such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15372
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015373Flags are :
15374 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015375 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015376 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15377 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015378
15379 Example:
15380
15381 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15382 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15383
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015384 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15385
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015386At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15387
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015388 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15389 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015390
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015391the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015392
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015393 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15394 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15395 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015396
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015397and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15398
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015399 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15400 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015401
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015402Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15403
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015404 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015405 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015406 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15407 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15408 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015409 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15410 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15411 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015412 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015413 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15414 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015415 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015416 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15417 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015418 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015419 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015420 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015421 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015422 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015423 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015424 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015425 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15426 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15427 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15428 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15429 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015430 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015431 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15432 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015433 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015434 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15435 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015436 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15437 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15438 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015439 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015440 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15441 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015442 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015443 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15444 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15445 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015446 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015447 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015448 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15449 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15450 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15451 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015452 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015453 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015454 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015455 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015456 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015457 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015458 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15459 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15460 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015461 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015462 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15463 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015464 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015465 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15466 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15467 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015468 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015469 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015470 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015471
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015472 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015473
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015474
154758.2.5. Error log format
15476-----------------------
15477
15478When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15479protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15480By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15481"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15482will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15483logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15484
15485The format looks like this :
15486
15487 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15488 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15489 Connection error during SSL handshake
15490
15491 Field Format Extract from the example above
15492 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15493 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15494 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15495 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15496 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15497
15498These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15499failures.
15500
15501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155028.3. Advanced logging options
15503-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015504
15505Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15506just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15507options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15508for more information about their usage.
15509
15510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155118.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15512------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015513
15514It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15515haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15516commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15517monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15518ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15519
15520 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15521 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15522 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15523 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15524
15525 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15526 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15527 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015528 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015529 such as other load-balancers.
15530
15531 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15532 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15533 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15534
15535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155368.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15537----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015538
15539The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15540what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15541or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15542"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15543just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15544log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15545after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15546is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15547with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15548with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15549
15550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155518.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15552------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015553
15554Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15555for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15556"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15557retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15558raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15559a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15560file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15561you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15562"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15563
15564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155658.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15566--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015567
15568Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15569multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15570them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15571"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15572logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15573error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15574and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15575too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15576useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15577alternative.
15578
15579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155808.4. Timing events
15581------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015582
15583Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15584reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15585the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15586frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015587mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15588addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15589
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015590Timings events in HTTP mode:
15591
15592 first request 2nd request
15593 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15594 t tr t tr ...
15595 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15596 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15597 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15598 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15599 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15600
15601Timings events in TCP mode:
15602
15603 TCP session
15604 |<----------------->|
15605 t t
15606 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15607 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15608 |<------ Tt ------->|
15609
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015610 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15611 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15612 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15613 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15614 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15615 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15616 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015617
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015618 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15619 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15620 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15621 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15622 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15623 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15624 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15625 nothing was received on the connection.
15626
15627 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15628 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15629 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15630 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15631 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15632 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15633 request typed by hand during a test.
15634
15635 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15636 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15637 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15638 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15639 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15640 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15641 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015642
15643 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15644 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15645 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15646 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15647 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15648
15649 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15650 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15651 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15652 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15653 connection never established.
15654
15655 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15656 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15657 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15658 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15659 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15660 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15661 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15662 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15663 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15664 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15665 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015667 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15668 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15669 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15670 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15671 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15672 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15673
15674 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15675
15676 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15677 "Ta" can never be negative.
15678
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015679 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15680 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015681 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15682 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015683 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015684
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015685 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015686
15687 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015688 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15689 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015690
15691These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15692protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15693that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015694due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15695"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15696that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015697
15698Most common cases :
15699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015700 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15701 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15702 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15703 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15704 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15705 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15706 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15707 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15708 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15709 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15710 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015711 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015712
15713 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15714 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15715 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15716 of ms on remote networks.
15717
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015718 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15719 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15720 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015721
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015722 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15723 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15724 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15725 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15726 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15727 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15728 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15729 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15730 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015731
15732Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15733
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015734 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015735 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015736 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015738 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015739 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15740 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15741
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015742 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015743 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15744 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15745 flags.
15746
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015747 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15748 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015749 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15750 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15751 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15752 the client connection was maintained open.
15753
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015754 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015755 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015756 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015757 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15758
15759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157608.5. Session state at disconnection
15761-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015762
15763TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15764"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
157652-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15766each of which has a special meaning :
15767
15768 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15769 session to terminate :
15770
15771 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15772
15773 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15774 server explicitly refused it.
15775
15776 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15777 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15778 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15779 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015780 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15781
15782 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15783 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015784
15785 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15786 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15787 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15788 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15789 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15790
15791 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15792 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15793 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15794 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15795 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15796
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015797 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15798 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15799
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015800 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15801 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15802 backup connections when going up.
15803
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015804 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15805
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015806 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15807 send or receive data.
15808
15809 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15810 send or receive data.
15811
15812 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15813 with nothing left in the buffers.
15814
15815 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15816
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015817 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015818 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15819
15820 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15821 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15822 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15823 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15824 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15825
15826 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15827 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15828
15829 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15830 server (HTTP only).
15831
15832 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15833
15834 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15835 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15836 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15837
15838 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15839 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15840 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15841
15842 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15843
15844 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15845 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15846
15847 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15848 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15849 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15850
15851 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15852 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015853 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15854 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015855
15856 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15857 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15858 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15859 another server.
15860
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015861 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015862 server.
15863
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015864 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15865 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15866 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15867 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15868
15869 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15870 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15871 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15872 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15873
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015874 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15875 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15876 "use-server" rule).
15877
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015878 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15879
15880 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15881 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15882
15883 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15884
15885 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15886 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15887 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15888
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015889 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15890 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015891 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015892 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15893 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15894
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015895 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15896
15897 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15898 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15899
15900 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15901
15902 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15903
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015904The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15905was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015906helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15907starvation, attacks, etc...
15908
15909The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15910alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15911easier finding and understanding.
15912
15913 Flags Reason
15914
15915 -- Normal termination.
15916
15917 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15918 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15919 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15920 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15921
15922 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15923 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15924 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15925 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15926 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15927 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015929 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15930 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015931 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015932
15933 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15934 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15935 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15936
15937 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15938 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15939 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15940 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15941 the server takes too long to respond.
15942
15943 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15944 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15945 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15946 long a time to respond.
15947
15948 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15949 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15950 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15951 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015952 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15953 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015954
15955 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15956 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15957 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15958 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15959 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015960 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015961 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15962 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15963 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15964 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15965 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15966 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15967 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15968 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15969 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15970 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15971 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15972 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015973
15974 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15975 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015976 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15977 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15978 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15979 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015980
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015981 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15982 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015984 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015985 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15986 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15987 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15988 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15989 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15990
15991 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15992 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15993 503 or 504 here.
15994
15995 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15996 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15997 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15998 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15999 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16000
16001 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16002 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016003 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016004 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16005 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16006
16007 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16008 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16009 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16010 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16011 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16012 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16013 between haproxy and the server.
16014
16015 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16016 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16017 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16018 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16019 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16020 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16021 solution is to fix the application.
16022
16023 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16024 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16025 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16026 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16027 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16028 external attacks.
16029
16030 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16031 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016032 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016033 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16034 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16035
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016036 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16037 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16038 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016039 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16040 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016042 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16043 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16044 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16045 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016046 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16047 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16048 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16049 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16050 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016051
16052 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16053 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16054 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16055 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16056
16057 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16058 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16059 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16060 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16061
16062 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16063 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16064 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16065 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16066
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016067The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16068persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16069important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16070re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16071
16072 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16073
16074 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16075 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16076 set on a GET request.
16077
16078 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16079 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016080 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016081 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16082
16083 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16084 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16085 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16086
16087 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16088 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16089 already got a cookie.
16090
16091 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16092 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16093 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16094 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16095 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16096
16097 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16098 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16099 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16100
16101 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16102 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16103 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16104
16105 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16106 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16107
16108 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16109 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16110 then advertised in the response.
16111
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161138.6. Non-printable characters
16114-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016115
16116In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16117consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16118converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16119prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16120being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16121escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16122is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16123'}' when logging headers.
16124
16125Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16126issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16127containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16128
16129Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16130the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16131performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16132
16133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161348.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16135---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016136
16137Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16138achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016139section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016140cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16141the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16142the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016143locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016144not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16145user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16146a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16147wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16148
16149 Examples :
16150 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16151 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16152
16153 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16154 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16155
16156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161578.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16158---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016159
16160Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16161proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16162the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16163server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16164
16165Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16166response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016167section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168
16169It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016170time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16171appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016172are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16173and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16174follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16175request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16176in the logs.
16177
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016178As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16179frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16180an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16181
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016182 Example :
16183 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16184 listen proxy-out
16185 mode http
16186 option httplog
16187 option logasap
16188 log global
16189 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16190
16191 # log the name of the virtual server
16192 capture request header Host len 20
16193
16194 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16195 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16196
16197 # log the beginning of the referrer
16198 capture request header Referer len 20
16199
16200 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16201 capture response header Server len 20
16202
16203 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16204 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16205
16206 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16207 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16208
16209 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16210 capture response header Via len 20
16211
16212 # log the URL location during a redirection
16213 capture response header Location len 20
16214
16215 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16216 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16217 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16218 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16219 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16220
16221 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16222 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16223 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16224 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016225 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016226
16227 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16228 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16229 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16230 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16231 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016232 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016233
16234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162358.9. Examples of logs
16236---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016237
16238These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16239them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16240reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16241
16242 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16243 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16244 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16245
16246 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16247 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16248
16249 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16250 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16251 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16252
16253 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16254 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16255
16256 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16257 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16258 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16259
16260 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016261 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016262 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16263 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16264
16265 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16266 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16267 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16268
16269 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16270 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016271 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016272 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16273 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16274 to return the 502 and not the server.
16275
16276 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016277 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016278
16279 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16280 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16281 Nothing was sent to any server.
16282
16283 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16284 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16285
16286 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16287 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16288 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16289 send a 408 return code to the client.
16290
16291 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16292 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16293
16294 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16295 5 seconds ("c----").
16296
16297 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16298 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016299 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016300
16301 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016302 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016303 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16304 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16305 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16306 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16307 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016308
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016309
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200163109. Supported filters
16311--------------------
16312
16313Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16314accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16315unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16316
16317See also : "filter"
16318
163199.1. Trace
16320----------
16321
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016322filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016323
16324 Arguments:
16325 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16326 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16327
16328 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16329 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16330 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16331 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16332
16333 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16334 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16335 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16336 amount of the parsed data.
16337
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016338 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16339
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016340This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16341callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16342information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16343filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16344
16345Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16346tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16347a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16348
16349
163509.2. HTTP compression
16351---------------------
16352
16353filter compression
16354
16355The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16356keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16357when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16358use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16359used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16360filters evaluation order.
16361
16362See also : "compression"
16363
16364
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200163659.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16366--------------------------------------------
16367
16368filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16369
16370 Arguments :
16371
16372 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16373 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16374 parsed.
16375
16376 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16377 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16378 part must be placed in its own scope.
16379
16380The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16381external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16382streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16383exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16384also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16385
16386SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16387the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16388
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016389For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016390"doc/SPOE.txt".
16391
16392Important note:
16393 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16394 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016396/*
16397 * Local variables:
16398 * fill-column: 79
16399 * End:
16400 */